Linux Audio

Check our new training course

Loading...
v6.13.7
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2/*
   3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   4 *
   5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   6 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   7 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2024 Intel Corporation
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
  16#include <linux/bug.h>
  17#include <linux/kernel.h>
  18#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  19#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  20#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  21#include <linux/lockdep.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  23#include <net/codel.h>
  24#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
  25#include <linux/unaligned.h>
  26
  27/**
  28 * DOC: Introduction
  29 *
  30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  33 * drivers.
  34 */
  35
  36/**
  37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  38 *
  39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  44 * tasklet function.
  45 *
  46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  47 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  48 */
  49
  50/**
  51 * DOC: Warning
  52 *
  53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  55 */
  56
  57/**
  58 * DOC: Frame format
  59 *
  60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  63 * hardware.
  64 *
  65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  66 *
  67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  69 *
  70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  72 */
  73
  74/**
  75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  76 *
  77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  81 *
  82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  83 * suspend.
  84 *
  85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  86 *
  87 */
  88
  89/**
  90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  91 *
  92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
  93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
  94 * different stations/interfaces.
  95 *
  96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
  97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
  98 * handler.
  99 *
 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 103 *
 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 106 *
 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
 109 * driver op.
 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
 113 *
 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 119 *
 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 124 * .release_buffered_frames().
 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 128 */
 129
 130/**
 131 * DOC: HW timestamping
 132 *
 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
 135 *
 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
 140 *
 141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
 145 */
 146struct device;
 147
 148/**
 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 150 *
 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 153 */
 154enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 155	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 156	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 157};
 158
 159#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 160
 161/**
 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 167 */
 168enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 169	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 170	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 171	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 172	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 173};
 174
 175/**
 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 177 *
 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 180 *
 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 183 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 190 */
 191struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 192	u16 txop;
 193	u16 cw_min;
 194	u16 cw_max;
 195	u8 aifs;
 196	bool acm;
 197	bool uapsd;
 198	bool mu_edca;
 199	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
 200};
 201
 202struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 203	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 204	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 205	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 206	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 207};
 208
 209/**
 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 215 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
 217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
 218 *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
 219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
 220 *	was changed.
 221 */
 222enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 223	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 224	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 225	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 226	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 227	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF	= BIT(4),
 228	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
 229	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
 230};
 231
 232/**
 233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
 234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
 235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
 236 *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
 237 */
 238struct ieee80211_chan_req {
 239	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
 240	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
 241};
 242
 243/**
 244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 245 *
 246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 248 *
 249 * @def: the channel definition
 250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
 252 *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
 253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
 254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 255 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 257 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 258 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 261 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 262 */
 263struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 264	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 265	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 266	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
 267
 268	int radio_idx;
 269	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 270
 271	bool radar_enabled;
 272
 273	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 274};
 275
 276/**
 277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 279 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 280 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 282 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 283 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 284 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 285 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 286 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 287 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 288 *      for changes/removal.)
 289 */
 290enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 291	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 292	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 293};
 294
 295/**
 296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 297 *
 298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 301 * done.
 302 *
 303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
 305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 307 */
 308struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 309	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 310	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
 311	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 312	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 313};
 314
 315/**
 316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 317 *
 318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
 319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
 320 *
 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 322 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 330 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 332 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 334 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 339 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 346 *	changed
 347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 348 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 350 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 351 *	context had been assigned.
 352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 355 *	keep alive) changed.
 356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 358 *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
 363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 364 *	status changed.
 365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
 366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
 367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
 368 */
 369enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 370	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 371	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 372	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 373	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 374	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 375	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 376	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 377	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 378	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 379	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 380	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 381	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 382	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 383	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 384	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 385	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 386	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 387	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 388	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 389	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 390	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 391	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 392	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 393	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 394	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 395	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 396	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
 397	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
 398	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
 399	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
 400	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
 401	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
 402	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
 403	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
 404	BSS_CHANGED_TPE			= BIT_ULL(35),
 405
 406	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 407};
 408
 409/*
 410 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 411 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 412 * filtering will be disabled.
 413 */
 414#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 415
 416/**
 417 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 418 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 419 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 420 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 421 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 422 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 423 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 424 */
 425enum ieee80211_event_type {
 426	RSSI_EVENT,
 427	MLME_EVENT,
 428	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 429	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 430};
 431
 432/**
 433 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 434 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 435 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 436 */
 437enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 438	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 439	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 440};
 441
 442/**
 443 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 444 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 445 */
 446struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 447	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 448};
 449
 450/**
 451 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 452 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 453 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 454 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 455 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 456 */
 457enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 458	AUTH_EVENT,
 459	ASSOC_EVENT,
 460	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 461	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 462};
 463
 464/**
 465 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 466 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 467 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 468 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 469 */
 470enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 471	MLME_SUCCESS,
 472	MLME_DENIED,
 473	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 474};
 475
 476/**
 477 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 478 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 479 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 480 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 481 */
 482struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 483	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 484	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 485	u16 reason;
 486};
 487
 488/**
 489 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 490 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 491 * @tid: the tid
 492 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 493 */
 494struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 495	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 496	u16 tid;
 497	u16 ssn;
 498};
 499
 500/**
 501 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 502 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 503 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 504 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 505 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 506 * @u:union holding the fields above
 507 */
 508struct ieee80211_event {
 509	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 510	union {
 511		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 512		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 513		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 514	} u;
 515};
 516
 517/**
 518 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 519 *
 520 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 521 *
 522 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 523 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 524 */
 525struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 526	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 527	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 528};
 529
 530/**
 531 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 532 *
 533 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 534 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 535 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 536 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 537 */
 538struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
 539	const u8 *lci;
 540	const u8 *civicloc;
 541	size_t lci_len;
 542	size_t civicloc_len;
 543};
 544
 545/**
 546 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
 547 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
 548 *
 549 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 550 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 551 */
 552struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
 553	u32 min_interval;
 554	u32 max_interval;
 555};
 556
 557#define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ	5
 558struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
 559	bool valid;
 560	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
 561	u8 count;
 562};
 563
 564#define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ	16
 565struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
 566	bool valid;
 567	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
 568	u8 count, n;
 569};
 570
 571/**
 572 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
 573 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
 574 *	(indexed by TX power category)
 575 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
 576 *	160, 320 MHz each
 577 *	(indexed by TX power category)
 578 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
 579 *	subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
 580 *	(indexed by TX power category)
 581 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
 582 *	each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
 583 *	(indexed by TX power category)
 584 */
 585struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
 586	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
 587	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
 588};
 589
 590/**
 591 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 592 *
 593 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 594 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 595 *
 596 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
 597 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
 598 *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
 599 *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
 600 *	responses.
 601 * @addr: (link) address used locally
 602 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
 603 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 604 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 
 
 605 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 606 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 607 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 608 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 609 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 610 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 611 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 612 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 613 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
 614 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 615 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 616 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 617 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 618 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 619 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 620 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 621 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 622 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 623 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 624 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 625 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 626 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 627 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 628 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 629 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 630 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 631 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 632 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 633 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 634 *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
 635 *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
 636 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 637 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 638 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 639 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 640 *	the current band.
 641 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 642 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 643 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 644 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 645 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 646 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 647 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 648 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 649 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 650 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 651 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 652 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 653 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 654 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 655 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 656 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 657 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 658 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 659 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 660 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 661 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 662 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 663 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 664 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 665 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 666 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 667 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 668 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 669 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 670 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 671 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 672 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 673 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 674 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 675 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 676 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 677 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 678 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 679 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 680 *	station.
 681 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 682 *	responder functionality.
 683 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 684 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 685 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 686 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 687 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 688 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 689 *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
 690 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 691 *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 692 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
 693 *	connected to (STA)
 694 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 695 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 696 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
 697 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 698 *	interval.
 699 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
 700 *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
 701 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
 702 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
 
 703 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
 704 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
 705 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
 
 
 706 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
 707 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
 708 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
 709 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
 710 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
 711 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
 712 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
 
 
 713 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
 714 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
 715 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
 716 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
 717 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 718 *	beamformer
 719 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 720 *	beamformee
 721 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 722 *	beamformer
 723 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 724 *	beamformee
 725 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 726 *	beamformer
 727 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 728 *	beamformee
 729 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
 730 *	beamformer
 731 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
 732 *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
 733 *	bandwidth
 734 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 735 *	beamformer
 736 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 737 *	beamformee
 738 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
 739 *	beamformer
 740 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
 741 *	reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
 742 *	bandwidth
 743 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
 744 *	information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
 745 *	beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
 746 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
 747 *	that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
 748 *	its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
 749 *	link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
 750 *	bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
 751 *	link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
 752 *	In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
 753 *	be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
 754 *	the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
 755 *	(as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
 756 */
 757struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 758	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 759	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
 760
 761	const u8 *bssid;
 762	unsigned int link_id;
 763	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
 764	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
 765	bool uora_exists;
 766	u8 uora_ocw_range;
 767	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
 768	bool he_support;
 769	bool twt_requester;
 770	bool twt_responder;
 771	bool twt_protected;
 772	bool twt_broadcast;
 773	/* erp related data */
 774	bool use_cts_prot;
 775	bool use_short_preamble;
 776	bool use_short_slot;
 777	bool enable_beacon;
 778	u8 dtim_period;
 779	u16 beacon_int;
 780	u16 assoc_capability;
 781	u64 sync_tsf;
 782	u32 sync_device_ts;
 783	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 784	u32 basic_rates;
 785	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 786	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 787	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 788	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 789	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 790	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 791	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 792	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
 793	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 794	bool qos;
 795	bool hidden_ssid;
 796	int txpower;
 797	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 798	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 799	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 800	u16 max_idle_period;
 801	bool protected_keep_alive;
 802	bool ftm_responder;
 803	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
 804	/* Multiple BSSID data */
 805	bool nontransmitted;
 806	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
 807	u8 bssid_index;
 808	u8 bssid_indicator;
 809	bool ema_ap;
 810	u8 profile_periodicity;
 811	struct {
 812		u32 params;
 813		u16 nss_set;
 814	} he_oper;
 815	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
 816	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 817	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
 818	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
 819	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
 820	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
 821
 822	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
 823
 824	u8 pwr_reduction;
 825	bool eht_support;
 826
 827	bool csa_active;
 828
 829	bool mu_mimo_owner;
 830	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
 831
 832	bool color_change_active;
 833	u8 color_change_color;
 834
 835	bool ht_ldpc;
 836	bool vht_ldpc;
 837	bool he_ldpc;
 838	bool vht_su_beamformer;
 839	bool vht_su_beamformee;
 840	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
 841	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
 842	bool he_su_beamformer;
 843	bool he_su_beamformee;
 844	bool he_mu_beamformer;
 845	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
 846	bool eht_su_beamformer;
 847	bool eht_su_beamformee;
 848	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
 849	bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
 850	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
 851	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
 852};
 853
 854/**
 855 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 856 *
 857 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 858 *
 859 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 860 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 861 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 862 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 863 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 864 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 865 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 866 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 867 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 868 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 869 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 870 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 872 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 873 *	station
 874 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 875 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 876 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 877 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 878 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 879 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 880 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 881 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 882 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 883 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 884 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 885 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 886 *	hardware queue.
 887 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 888 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 889 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 890 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 891 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 892 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 893 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 894 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 895 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 896 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 897 *	off-channel operation.
 898 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 899 *	(header conversion)
 900 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 901 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 902 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 903 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 904 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 905 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 906 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 907 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 908 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 909 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 910 *	queue gets full.
 911 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 912 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 913 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 914 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 915 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 916 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 917 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 918 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 919 *	status to user space)
 920 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 922 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 924 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 925 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 926 *	handled properly by the device.
 927 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 928 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 929 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 930 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 931 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 932 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 933 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 934 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 935 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 936 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 937 *	PS-Poll responses.
 938 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 939 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 940 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 941 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 942 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 943 *	monitor injection).
 944 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 945 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 946 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 947 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 948 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 949 *
 950 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 951 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 952 */
 953enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 954	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 955	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 956	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 957	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 958	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 959	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 960	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 961	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 962	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 963	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 964	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 965	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 966	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 967	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 968	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
 969	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 970	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 971	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 972	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 973	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 974	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 975	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 976	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 977	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 978	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 979	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 980	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 981	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 982	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 983	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 984	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 985};
 986
 987#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 988
 989#define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
 990
 991/**
 992 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 993 *
 994 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 995 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 996 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 997 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 998 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 999 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1000 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1003 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1004 *	it can be sent out.
1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1006 *	has already been assigned to this frame.
1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1008 *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1009 *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1010 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1011 *	for sequence number assignment
1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1013 *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1014 *	operation on the interface.
1015 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1016 *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1017 *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1018 *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1019 *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1020 *	it's intended for an MLD.
1021 *
1022 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1023 */
1024enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1025	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
1026	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
1027	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
1028	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
1029	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
1030	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
1031	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
1032	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
1033	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
1034	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
1035	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
1036	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
1037};
1038
1039#define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
1040#define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
1041	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1042			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1043
1044/**
1045 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1046 *
1047 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1048 *
1049 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1050 */
1051enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1052	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1053};
1054
1055/*
1056 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1057 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1058 */
1059#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1060	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1061	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1062	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1063	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1064	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1065	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1066	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1067
1068/**
1069 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1070 *	Rate Control algorithm.
1071 *
1072 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1073 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1074 *
1075 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1076 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1077 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1078 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1079 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1080 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1081 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1082 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1083 *	Greenfield mode.
1084 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1085 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1086 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1087 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1088 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1089 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1090 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1091 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1092 */
1093enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1094	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1095	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1096	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1097
1098	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1099	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1100	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1101	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1102	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1103	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1104	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1105	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1106	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1107};
1108
1109
1110/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1111#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1112
1113/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1114#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1115
1116/* maximum number of rate stages */
1117#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1118
1119/* maximum number of rate table entries */
1120#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1121
1122/**
1123 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1124 *
1125 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1126 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1127 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1128 *
1129 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1130 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1131 *
1132 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1133 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1134 *
1135 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1136 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1137 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1138 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1139 * information::
1140 *
1141 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1142 *
1143 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1144 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1145 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1146 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1147 * information should then contain::
1148 *
1149 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1150 *
1151 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1152 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1153 */
1154struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1155	s8 idx;
1156	u16 count:5,
1157	    flags:11;
1158} __packed;
1159
1160#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1161
1162static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1163{
1164	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1165}
1166
1167static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1168					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1169{
1170	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1171	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1172	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1173}
1174
1175static inline u8
1176ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1177{
1178	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1179}
1180
1181static inline u8
1182ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1183{
1184	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1185}
1186
1187/**
1188 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1189 *
1190 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1191 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1192 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1193 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1194 *
1195 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1196 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1197 *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1198 *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1199 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1200 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1201 *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1202 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1203 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1204 * @control: union part for control data
1205 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1206 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1207 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1208 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1209 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1210 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1211 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1212 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1213 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1214 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1215 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1216 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1217 * @pad: padding
1218 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1219 * @status: union part for status data
1220 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1221 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1222 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1223 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1224 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1225 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1226 *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1227 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1228 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1229 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1230 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1231 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 
 
 
 
 
1232 */
1233struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1234	/* common information */
1235	u32 flags;
1236	u32 band:3,
1237	    status_data_idr:1,
1238	    status_data:13,
1239	    hw_queue:4,
1240	    tx_time_est:10;
1241	/* 1 free bit */
1242
1243	union {
1244		struct {
1245			union {
1246				/* rate control */
1247				struct {
1248					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1249						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1250					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1251					u8 use_rts:1;
1252					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1253					u8 short_preamble:1;
1254					u8 skip_table:1;
1255
1256					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1257					u8 antennas:2;
1258
1259					/* 14 bits free */
1260				};
1261				/* only needed before rate control */
1262				unsigned long jiffies;
1263			};
1264			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1265			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1266			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1267			u32 flags;
1268			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1269		} control;
1270		struct {
1271			u64 cookie;
1272		} ack;
1273		struct {
1274			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1275			s32 ack_signal;
1276			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1277			u8 ampdu_len;
1278			u8 antenna;
1279			u8 pad;
1280			u16 tx_time;
1281			u8 flags;
1282			u8 pad2;
1283			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1284		} status;
1285		struct {
1286			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1287				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1288			u8 pad[4];
1289
1290			void *rate_driver_data[
1291				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1292		};
1293		void *driver_data[
1294			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1295	};
1296};
1297
1298static inline u16
1299ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1300{
1301	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1302	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1303	 */
1304	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1305	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1306}
1307
1308static inline u16
1309ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1310{
1311	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1312}
1313
1314/***
1315 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1316 *
1317 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1318 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1319 *
1320 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1321 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1322 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1323 * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1324 * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1325 */
1326struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1327	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1328	u8 try_count;
1329	u8 tx_power_idx;
1330};
1331
1332/**
1333 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1334 *
1335 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1336 * @info: Basic tx status information
1337 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1338 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1339 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1340 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1341 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1342 *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1343 *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1344 */
1345struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1346	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1347	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1348	struct sk_buff *skb;
1349	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1350	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1351	u8 n_rates;
1352
1353	struct list_head *free_list;
1354};
1355
1356/**
1357 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1358 *
1359 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1360 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1361 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1362 *
1363 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1364 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1365 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1366 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1367 */
1368struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1369	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1370	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1371	const u8 *common_ies;
1372	size_t common_ie_len;
1373};
1374
1375
1376static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1377{
1378	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1379}
1380
1381static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1382{
1383	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1384}
1385
1386/**
1387 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1388 *
1389 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1390 *
1391 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1392 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1393 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1394 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1395 *
1396 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1397 *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1398 *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1399 */
1400static inline void
1401ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1402{
1403	int i;
1404
1405	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1406		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1407	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1408		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1409	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1410	/* clear the rate counts */
1411	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1412		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1413	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1414}
1415
1416
1417/**
1418 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1419 *
1420 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1421 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1422 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1423 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1424 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1425 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1426 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1427 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1428 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1429 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1430 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1431 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1432 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1433 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1434 *	de-duplication by itself.
1435 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1436 *	the frame.
1437 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1438 *	the frame.
1439 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1440 *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1441 *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1442 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1443 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1444 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1445 *	merging.
1446 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1447 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1448 *	(including FCS) was received.
1449 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1450 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1451 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1452 *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1453 *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1454 *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1455 *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1456 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1457 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1458 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1459 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1460 *	each A-MPDU
1461 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1462 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1463 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1464 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1465 *	on this subframe
 
 
1466 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1467 *	done by the hardware
1468 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1469 *	processing it in any regular way.
1470 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1471 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1472 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1473 *	monitor interfaces.
1474 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1475 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1476 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1477 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1478 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1479 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1480 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1481 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1482 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1483 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1484 *	interleaved with other frames.
1485 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1486 *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1487 *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1488 *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1489 *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1490 *	in the skb.
1491 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1492 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1493 *	the first subframe.
1494 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1495 *	be done in the hardware.
1496 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1497 *	frame
1498 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1499 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1500 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1501 *	
1502 *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1503 *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1504 *	 - DATA3_CODING
1505 *	 - DATA5_GI
1506 *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1507 *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1508 *	 - DATA3_STBC
1509 *	
1510 *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1511 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1512 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1513 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1514 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1515 *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1516 *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1517 *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1518 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1519 *	hardware or driver)
1520 */
1521enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1522	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1523	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1524	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1525	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1526	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1527	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1528	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1529	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1530	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1531	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1532	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1533	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1534	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1535	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1536	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1537	/* one free bit at 15 */
1538	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1539	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1540	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1541	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1542	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1543	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1544	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1545	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1546	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1547	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1548	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1549	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1550	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1551	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1552	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1553	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1554	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1555};
1556
1557/**
1558 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1559 *
1560 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1561 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1562 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1563 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1564 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1565 *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1566 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1567 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1568 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1569 */
1570enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1571	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1572	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1573	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1574	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1575	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1576	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1577};
1578
1579#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1580
1581enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1582	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1583	RX_ENC_HT,
1584	RX_ENC_VHT,
1585	RX_ENC_HE,
1586	RX_ENC_EHT,
1587};
1588
1589/**
1590 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1591 *
1592 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1593 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1594 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1595 *
1596 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1597 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1598 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1599 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1600 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1601 *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1602 *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1603 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1604 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1605 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1606 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1607 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1608 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1609 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1610 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1611 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1612 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1613 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1614 *	values were filled.
1615 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1616 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1617 * @antenna: antenna used
1618 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1619 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1620 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1621 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1622 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1623 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1624 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1625 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1626 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1627 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1628 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1629 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1630 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1631 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1632 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1633 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
 
1634 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1635 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1636 *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1637 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1638 *	@link_valid.
1639 */
1640struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1641	u64 mactime;
1642	union {
1643		u64 boottime_ns;
1644		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1645	};
1646	u32 device_timestamp;
1647	u32 ampdu_reference;
1648	u32 flag;
1649	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1650	u8 enc_flags;
1651	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1652	union {
1653		struct {
1654			u8 he_ru:3;
1655			u8 he_gi:2;
1656			u8 he_dcm:1;
1657		};
1658		struct {
1659			u8 ru:4;
1660			u8 gi:2;
1661		} eht;
1662	};
1663	u8 rate_idx;
1664	u8 nss;
1665	u8 rx_flags;
1666	u8 band;
1667	u8 antenna;
1668	s8 signal;
1669	u8 chains;
1670	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
 
1671	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1672	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1673};
1674
1675static inline u32
1676ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1677{
1678	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1679	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1680}
1681
1682/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1683 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1684 *
1685 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1686 *
1687 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1688 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1689 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1690 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1691 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1692 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1693 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1694 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1695 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1696 *	for more.
1697 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1698 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1699 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1700 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1701 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1702 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1703 *	operating channel.
1704 */
1705enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1706	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1707	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1708	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1709	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1710};
1711
1712
1713/**
1714 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1715 *
1716 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1717 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1718 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1719 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1720 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1721 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1722 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1723 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1724 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1725 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1726 */
1727enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1728	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1729	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1730	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1731	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1732	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1733	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1734	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1735	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1736};
1737
1738/**
1739 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1740 *
1741 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1742 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1743 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1744 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1745 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1746 */
1747enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1748	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1749	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1750	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1751	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1752
1753	/* keep last */
1754	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1755};
1756
1757/**
1758 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1759 *
1760 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1761 *
1762 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1763 *
1764 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1765 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1766 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1767 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1768 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1769 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1770 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1771 *
1772 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1773 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1774 *
1775 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1776 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1777 *
1778 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1779 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1780 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1781 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1782 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1783 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1784 *
1785 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1786 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1787 *	configured for an HT channel.
1788 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1789 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1790 */
1791struct ieee80211_conf {
1792	u32 flags;
1793	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1794
1795	u16 listen_interval;
1796	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1797
1798	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1799
1800	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1801	bool radar_enabled;
1802	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1803};
1804
1805/**
1806 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1807 *
1808 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1809 * operation.
1810 *
1811 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1812 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1813 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1814 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1815 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1816 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1817 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1818 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1819 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1820 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1821 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1822 *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1823 *	channel, expressed in TU.
1824 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1825 */
1826struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1827	u64 timestamp;
1828	u32 device_timestamp;
1829	bool block_tx;
1830	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1831	u8 count;
1832	u8 link_id;
1833	u32 delay;
1834};
1835
1836/**
1837 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1838 *
1839 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1840 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1841 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1842 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1843 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1844 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1845 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1846 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1847 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1848 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1849 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1850 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1851 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1852 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1853 *      enabled for the interface.
1854 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1855 *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1856 *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1857 *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1858 */
1859enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1860	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1861	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1862	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1863	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1864	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1865	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1866};
1867
1868
1869/**
1870 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1871 *
1872 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1873 *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1874 *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1875 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1876 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1877 *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1878 *	mac80211.
1879 */
1880
1881enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1882	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1883	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1884	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1885};
1886
1887/**
1888 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1889 * @assoc: association status
1890 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1891 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1892 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1893 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1894 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1895 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1896 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1897 *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1898 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1899 *	Figure 9-1001k
1900 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1901 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1902 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1903 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1904 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1905 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1906 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1907 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1908 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1909 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1910 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1911 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1912 *	your driver/device needs to do.
1913 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1914 *	(station mode only)
1915 */
1916struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1917	/* association related data */
1918	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1919	bool ibss_creator;
1920	bool ps;
1921	u16 aid;
1922	u16 eml_cap;
1923	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1924	u16 mld_capa_op;
1925
1926	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1927	int arp_addr_cnt;
1928	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1929	size_t ssid_len;
1930	bool s1g;
1931	bool idle;
1932	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1933};
1934
1935#define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1936
1937/**
1938 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1939 *
1940 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1941 *	this TID is not included.
1942 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1943 *	TID is not included.
1944 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1945 */
1946struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1947	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1948	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1949	bool valid;
1950};
1951
1952/**
1953 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1954 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1955 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1956 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1957 */
1958enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1959	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1960	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1961	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1962};
1963
1964/**
1965 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1966 *
1967 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1968 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1969 *
1970 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1971 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1972 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1973 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1974 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1975 *	indexed by link ID
1976 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1977 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1978 *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1979 *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1980 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1981 *	due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1982 *	0 for non-MLO.
1983 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1984 *	suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1985 *	future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1986 *	0 for non-MLO.
1987 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1988 *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1989 * @addr: address of this interface
1990 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
1991 *	passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
1992 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1993 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1994 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1995 *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1996 *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1997 *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1998 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1999 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2000 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2001 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2002 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2003 *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2004 *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2005 *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2006 *	restrictions.
2007 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2008 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2009 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2010 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2011 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2012 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2013 *	interface.
2014 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2015 *	for this interface.
2016 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2017 *	sizeof(void \*).
2018 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2019 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2020 *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2021 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2022 */
2023struct ieee80211_vif {
2024	enum nl80211_iftype type;
2025	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2026	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2027	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2028	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2029	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2030	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2031	bool addr_valid;
2032	bool p2p;
2033
2034	u8 cab_queue;
2035	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2036
2037	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2038
2039	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2040	u32 driver_flags;
2041	u32 offload_flags;
2042
2043#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2044	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2045#endif
2046
2047	bool probe_req_reg;
2048	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2049
2050	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2051
2052	/* must be last */
2053	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2054};
2055
2056/**
2057 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2058 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2059 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2060 */
2061static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2062{
2063	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2064}
2065
2066/**
2067 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2068 * @vif: the vif
2069 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2070 */
2071static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2072{
2073	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2074	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2075}
2076
2077/**
2078 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2079 * @vif: the vif
2080 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2081 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2082 *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2083 */
2084static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2085					     unsigned int link_id)
2086{
2087	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2088		return link_id == 0;
2089	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2090}
2091
2092#define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2093	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2094		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2095		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2096		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2097
2098static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2099{
2100#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2101	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2102#endif
2103	return false;
2104}
2105
2106/**
2107 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2108 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2109 *
2110 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2111 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2112 *
2113 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2114 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2115 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2116 */
2117struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2118
2119/**
2120 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2121 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2122 *
2123 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2124 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2125 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2126 *
2127 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2128 */
2129struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2130
2131static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
 
 
 
 
2132{
2133	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2134}
2135
2136#define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2137	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2138				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2139
2140#define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2141	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2142			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2143
2144/**
2145 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2146 *
2147 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2148 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2149 *
2150 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2151 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2152 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2153 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2154 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2155 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2156 *	generation in software.
2157 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2158 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2159 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2160 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2161 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2162 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2163 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2164 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2165 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2166 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2167 *	MIC.
2168 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2169 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2170 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2171 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2172 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2173 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2174 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2175 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2176 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2177 *	only for management frames (MFP).
2178 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2179 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2180 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2181 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2182 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2183 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2184 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2185 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2186 *	for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2187 *	number generation only
2188 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2189 *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2190 */
2191enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2192	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2193	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2194	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2195	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2196	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2197	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2198	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2199	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2200	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2201	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2202	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2203	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2204};
2205
2206/**
2207 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2208 *
2209 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2210 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2211 *
2212 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2213 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2214 *	encrypted in hardware.
2215 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2216 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2217 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2218 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2219 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2220 * @keylen: key material length
2221 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2222 * 	data block:
2223 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2224 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2225 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2226 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2227 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2228 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2229 */
2230struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2231	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2232	u32 cipher;
2233	u8 icv_len;
2234	u8 iv_len;
2235	u8 hw_key_idx;
2236	s8 keyidx;
2237	u16 flags;
2238	s8 link_id;
2239	u8 keylen;
2240	u8 key[];
2241};
2242
2243#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2244
2245#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2246#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2247
2248/**
2249 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2250 *
2251 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2252 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2253 *	reverse order than in packet)
2254 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2255 *	reverse order than in packet)
2256 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2257 *	reverse order than in packet)
2258 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2259 *	reverse order than in packet)
2260 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2261 */
2262struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2263	union {
2264		struct {
2265			u32 iv32;
2266			u16 iv16;
2267		} tkip;
2268		struct {
2269			u8 pn[6];
2270		} ccmp;
2271		struct {
2272			u8 pn[6];
2273		} aes_cmac;
2274		struct {
2275			u8 pn[6];
2276		} aes_gmac;
2277		struct {
2278			u8 pn[6];
2279		} gcmp;
2280		struct {
2281			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2282			u8 seq_len;
2283		} hw;
2284	};
2285};
2286
2287/**
2288 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2289 *
2290 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2291 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2292 *
2293 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2294 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2295 */
2296enum set_key_cmd {
2297	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2298};
2299
2300/**
2301 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2302 *
2303 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2304 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2305 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2306 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2307 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2308 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2309 */
2310enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2311	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2312	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2313	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2314	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2315	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2316	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2317};
2318
2319/**
2320 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2321 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2322 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2323 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2324 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2325 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2326 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2327 *
2328 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2329 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2330 */
2331enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2332	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2333	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2334	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2335	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2336	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2337};
2338
2339/**
2340 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2341 *
2342 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2343 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2344 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2345 */
2346struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2347	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2348	struct {
2349		s8 idx;
2350		u8 count;
2351		u8 count_cts;
2352		u8 count_rts;
2353		u16 flags;
2354	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2355};
2356
2357/**
2358 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2359 *
2360 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2361 *
2362 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2363 *	to the STA.
2364 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2365 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2366 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2367 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2368 *	per peer TPC.
2369 */
2370struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2371	s16 power;
2372	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2373};
2374
2375/**
2376 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2377 *
2378 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2379 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2380 *
2381 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2382 *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2383 *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2384 *
2385 *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2386 *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2387 *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2388 *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2389 *
2390 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2391 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2392 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2393 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2394 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2395 */
2396struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2397	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2398
2399	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2400	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2401};
2402
2403/**
2404 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2405 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2406 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2407 *
2408 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2409 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2410 *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2411 *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2412 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2413 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2414 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2415 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2416 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2417 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2418 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2419 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2420 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2421 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2422 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2423 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2424 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2425 *	the station moves to associated state.
2426 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2427 *
2428 */
2429struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2430	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2431
2432	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2433	u8 link_id;
2434	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2435
2436	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2437	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2438	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2439	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2440	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2441	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2442
2443	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2444
2445	u8 rx_nss;
2446	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2447	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2448};
2449
2450/**
2451 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2452 *
2453 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2454 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2455 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2456 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2457 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2458 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2459 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2460 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2461 *
2462 * @addr: MAC address
2463 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2464 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2465 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2466 *	Can be modified by driver.
2467 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2468 *	otherwise always false)
2469 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2470 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2471 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2472 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2473 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2474 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2475 * @rates: rate control selection table
2476 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2477 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2478 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2479 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2480 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2481 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2482 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2483 *	unlimited.
2484 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2485 *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2486 *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2487 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2488 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2489 *	is used for non-data frames
2490 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2491 *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2492 *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2493 *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2494 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2495 *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2496 *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2497 *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2498 *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2499 *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2500 *	by the AP.
2501 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2502 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2503 */
2504struct ieee80211_sta {
2505	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2506	u16 aid;
2507	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2508	bool wme;
2509	u8 uapsd_queues;
2510	u8 max_sp;
2511	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2512	bool tdls;
2513	bool tdls_initiator;
2514	bool mfp;
2515	bool mlo;
2516	bool spp_amsdu;
2517	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2518
2519	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2520
2521	bool support_p2p_ps;
2522
2523	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2524
2525	u16 valid_links;
2526	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2527	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2528
2529	/* must be last */
2530	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2531};
2532
2533#ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2534bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2535#else
2536static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2537{
2538	return true;
2539}
2540#endif
2541
2542#define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2543	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2544				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2545
2546#define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2547	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2548			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2549
2550#define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2551	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2552		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2553		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2554		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2555
2556/**
2557 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2558 *
2559 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2560 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2561 *
2562 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2563 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2564 */
2565enum sta_notify_cmd {
2566	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2567};
2568
2569/**
2570 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2571 *
2572 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2573 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2574 */
2575struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2576	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2577};
2578
2579/**
2580 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2581 *
2582 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2583 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2584 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2585 *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2586 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2587 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2588 *
2589 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2590 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2591 */
2592struct ieee80211_txq {
2593	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2594	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2595	u8 tid;
2596	u8 ac;
2597
2598	/* must be last */
2599	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2600};
2601
2602/**
2603 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2604 *
2605 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2606 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2607 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2608 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2609 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2610 *
2611 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2612 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2613 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2614 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2615 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2616 *	algorithm.
2617 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2618 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2619 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2620 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2621 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2622 *	CCK frames.
2623 *
2624 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2625 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2626 *	the FCS at the end.
2627 *
2628 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2629 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2630 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2631 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2632 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2633 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2634 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2635 *
2636 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2637 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2638 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2639 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2640 *
2641 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2642 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2643 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2644 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2645 *
2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2647 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2648 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2649 *
2650 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2651 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2652 *
2653 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2654 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2655 *
2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2657 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2658 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2659 *
2660 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2661 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2662 *
2663 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2664 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2665 *
2666 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2667 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2668 *	the stack.
2669 *
2670 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2671 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2672 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2673 *
2674 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2675 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2676 *	dtim_period).
2677 *
2678 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2679 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2680 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2681 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2682 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2683 *	only in that case.
2684 *
2685 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2686 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2687 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2688 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2689 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2690 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2691 *
2692 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2693 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2694 *	software.
2695 *
2696 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2697 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2698 *	active interfaces.
2699 *
2700 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2701 *	of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2702 *	This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2703 *	channels.
2704 *
2705 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2706 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2707 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2708 *
2709 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2710 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2711 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2712 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2713 *	supported cipher suites.
2714 *
2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2716 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2717 *	for frames.
2718 *
2719 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2720 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2721 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2722 *	control for more details.
2723 *
2724 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2725 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2726 *
2727 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2728 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2729 *	is supported.
2730 *
2731 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2732 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2733 *
2734 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2735 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2736 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2737 *
2738 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2739 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2740 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2741 *	CSA frame.
2742 *
2743 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2744 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2745 *
2746 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2747 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2748 *
2749 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2750 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2751 *
2752 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2753 *	within A-MPDU.
2754 *
2755 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2756 *	for sent beacons.
2757 *
2758 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2759 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2760 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2761 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2762 *
2763 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2764 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2765 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2766 *	timeout.
2767 *
2768 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2769 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2770 *
2771 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2772 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2773 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2774 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2775 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2776 *
2777 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2778 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2779 *
2780 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2781 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2782 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2783 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2784 *
2785 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2786 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2787 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2788 *
2789 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2790 *	TDLS links.
2791 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2792 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2793 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2794 *
2795 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2796 *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2797 *
2798 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2799 *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2800 *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2801 *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2802 *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2803 *
2804 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2805 *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2806 *	TXQs to start with.
2807 *
2808 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2809 *	length in tx status information
2810 *
2811 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2812 *
2813 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2814 *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2815 *
2816 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2817 *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2818 *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2819 *
2820 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2821 *	offload
2822 *
2823 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2824 *	offload
2825 *
2826 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2827 *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2828 *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2829 *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2830 *	the stack.
2831 *
2832 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2833 *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2834 *
2835 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2836 *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2837 *
2838 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2839 *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2840 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2841 *	EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2842 *
2843 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2844 *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2845 *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2846 *	link is switching.
2847 *
2848 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2849 */
2850enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2851	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2852	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2853	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2854	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2855	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2856	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2857	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2858	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2859	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2860	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2861	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2862	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2863	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2864	IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2865	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2866	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2867	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2868	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2869	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2870	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2871	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2872	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2873	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2874	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2875	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2876	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2877	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2878	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2879	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2880	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2881	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2882	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2883	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2884	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2885	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2886	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2887	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2888	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2889	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2890	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2891	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
 
2892	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2893	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2894	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2895	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2896	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2897	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2898	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2899	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2900	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2901	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2902	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2903	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2904	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2905	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2906	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2907	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2908
2909	/* keep last, obviously */
2910	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2911};
2912
2913/**
2914 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2915 *
2916 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2917 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2918 *
2919 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2920 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2921 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2922 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2923 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2924 *
2925 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2926 *
2927 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2928 *	along with this structure.
2929 *
2930 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2931 *
2932 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2933 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2934 *
2935 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2936 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2937 *
2938 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2939 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2940 *
2941 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2942 *	that HW supports
2943 *
2944 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2945 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2946 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2947 *
2948 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2949 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2950 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2951 *
2952 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2953 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2954 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2955 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2956 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2957 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2958 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2959 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2960 *
2961 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2962 *	can handle.
2963 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2964 *	the hw can report back.
2965 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2966 *
2967 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2968 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2969 *	aggregation.
2970 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2971 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2972 *	it shouldn't be set.
2973 *
2974 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2975 *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2976 *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2977 *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2978 *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2979 *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2980 *
2981 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2982 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2983 *
2984 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2985 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2986 *
2987 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2988 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2989 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2990 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2991 *
2992 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2993 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2994 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2995 *
 
 
2996 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2997 *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2998 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2999 *	device_timestamp.
3000 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3001 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3002 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3003 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3004 *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3005 *
3006 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3007 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3008 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3009 *
3010 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3011 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3012 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3013 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3014 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3015 *	neither enabled.
3016 *
3017 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3018 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3019 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3020 *
3021 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3022 *	device.
3023 *
3024 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3025 *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3026 *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3027 *
3028 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3029 *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3030 *
3031 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3032 *
3033 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3034 * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3035 * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3036 *
3037 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3038 */
3039struct ieee80211_hw {
3040	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3041	struct wiphy *wiphy;
3042	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3043	void *priv;
3044	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3045	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3046	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3047	int vif_data_size;
3048	int sta_data_size;
3049	int chanctx_data_size;
3050	int txq_data_size;
3051	u16 queues;
3052	u16 max_listen_interval;
3053	s8 max_signal;
3054	u8 max_rates;
3055	u8 max_report_rates;
3056	u8 max_rate_tries;
3057	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3058	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3059	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3060	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3061	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3062	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3063	struct {
3064		int units_pos;
3065		s16 accuracy;
3066	} radiotap_timestamp;
3067	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3068	u8 uapsd_queues;
3069	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3070	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3071	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3072	u8 weight_multiplier;
3073	u32 max_mtu;
3074	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3075	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3076};
3077
3078static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3079				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3080{
3081	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3082}
3083#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3084
3085static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3086				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3087{
3088	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3089}
3090#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3091
3092/**
3093 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3094 *
3095 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3096 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3097 */
3098struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3099	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3100
3101	/* Keep last */
3102	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3103};
3104
3105/**
3106 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3107 *
3108 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3109 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3110 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3111 * @status: channel-switch response status
3112 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3113 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3114 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3115 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3116 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3117 */
3118struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3119	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3120	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3121	u8 action_code;
3122	u32 status;
3123	u32 timestamp;
3124	u16 switch_time;
3125	u16 switch_timeout;
3126	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3127	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3128};
3129
3130/**
3131 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3132 *
3133 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3134 *
3135 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3136 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3137 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3138 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3139 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3140 *
3141 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3142 */
3143struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3144
3145/**
3146 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3147 *
3148 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3149 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3150 */
3151static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3152{
3153	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3154}
3155
3156/**
3157 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3158 *
3159 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3160 * @addr: the address to set
3161 */
3162static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3163{
3164	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3165}
3166
3167static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3168ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3169		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3170{
3171	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3172		return NULL;
3173	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3174}
3175
3176static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3177ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3178			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3179{
3180	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3181		return NULL;
3182	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3183}
3184
3185static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3186ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3187			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3188{
3189	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3190		return NULL;
3191	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3192}
3193
3194/**
3195 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3196 * @hw: the hardware
3197 * @skb: the skb
3198 *
3199 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3200 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3201 */
3202void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3203
3204/**
3205 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3206 * @hw: the hardware
3207 * @skbs: the skbs
3208 *
3209 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3210 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3211 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3212 * relevant locks to use it.
3213 */
3214void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3215			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3216
3217/**
3218 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3219 *
3220 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3221 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3222 *
3223 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3224 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3225 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3226 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3227 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3228 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3229 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3230 *
3231 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3232 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3233 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3234 *
3235 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3236 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3237 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3238 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3239 *
3240 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3241 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3242 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3243 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3244 *
3245 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3246 *
3247 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3248 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3249 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3250 * based on the receive flags.
3251 *
3252 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3253 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3254 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3255 * keys.
3256 *
3257 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3258 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3259 * handler.
3260 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3261 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3262 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3263 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3264 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3265 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3266 *
3267 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3268 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3269 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3270 *
3271 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3272 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3273 * requirements:
3274 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3275      once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3276   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3277      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3278   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3279      encrypted with the new key when also needing
3280      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3281   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3282   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3283 */
3284
3285/**
3286 * DOC: Powersave support
3287 *
3288 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3289 *
3290 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3291 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3292 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3293 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3294 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3295 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3296 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3297 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3298 *
3299 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3300 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3301 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3302 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3303 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3304 *
3305 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3306 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3307 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3308 *
3309 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3310 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3311 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3312 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3313 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3314 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3315 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3316 *
3317 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3318 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3319 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3320 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3321 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3322 * periods.
3323 *
3324 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3325 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3326 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3327 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3328 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3329 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3330 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3331 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3332 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3333 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3334 *
3335 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3336 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3337 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3338 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3339 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3340 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3341 *
3342 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3343 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3344 */
3345
3346/**
3347 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3348 *
3349 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3350 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3351 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3352 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3353 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3354 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3355 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3356 *
3357 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3358 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3359 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3360 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3361 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3362 *
3363 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3364 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3365 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3366 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3367 *
3368 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3369 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3370 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3371 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3372 *
3373 *  - a list of information element IDs
3374 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3375 *
3376 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3377 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3378 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3379 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3380 * vendor information elements.
3381 *
3382 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3383 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3384 *
3385 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3386 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3387 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3388 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3389 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3390 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3391 *
3392 *
3393 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3394 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3395 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3396 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3397 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3398 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3399 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3400 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3401 *
3402 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3403 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3404 * signal strength threshold checking.
3405 */
3406
3407/**
3408 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3409 *
3410 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3411 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3412 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3413 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3414 *
3415 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3416 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3417 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3418 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3419 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3420 * hardware flags.
3421 *
3422 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3423 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3424 * turned off otherwise.
3425 *
3426 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3427 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3428 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3429 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3430 */
3431
3432/**
3433 * DOC: Frame filtering
3434 *
3435 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3436 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3437 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3438 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3439 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3440 *
3441 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3442 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3443 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3444 *
3445 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3446 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3447 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3448 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3449 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3450 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3451 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3452 *
3453 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3454 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3455 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3456 * or dropped.
3457 *
3458 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3459 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3460 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3461 * the flag, but not clear it.
3462 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3463 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3464 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3465 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3466 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3467 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3468 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3469 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3470 */
3471
3472/**
3473 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3474 *
3475 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3476 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3477 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3478 *
3479 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3480 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3481 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3482 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3483 * the driver code.
3484 *
3485 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3486 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3487 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3488 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3489 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3490 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3491 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3492 *
3493 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3494 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3495 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3496 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3497 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3498 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3499 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3500 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3501 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3502 * @sta_notify callback.
3503 *
3504 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3505 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3506 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3507 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3508 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3509 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3510 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3511 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3512 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3513 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3514 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3515 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3516 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3517 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3518 *
3519 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3520 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3521 *
3522 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3523 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3524 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3525 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3526 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3527 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3528 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3529 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3530 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3531 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3532 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3533 *
3534 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3535 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3536 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3537 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3538 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3539 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3540 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3541 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3542 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3543 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3544 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3545 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3546 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3547 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3548 *
3549 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3550 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3551 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3552 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3553 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3554 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3555 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3556 *
3557 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3558 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3559 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3560 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3561 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3562 *
3563 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3564 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3565 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3566 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3567 */
3568
3569/**
3570 * DOC: HW queue control
3571 *
3572 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3573 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3574 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3575 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3576 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3577 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3578 *
3579 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3580 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3581 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3582 *
3583 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3584 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3585 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3586 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3587 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3588 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3589 * the hardware queue.
3590 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3591 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3592 *
3593 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3594 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3595 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3596 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3597 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3598 *
3599 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3600 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3601 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3602 * off-channel queue:         9
3603 *
3604 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3605 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3606 *
3607 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3608 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3609 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3610 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3611 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3612 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3613 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3614 *
3615 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3616 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3617 *
3618 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3619 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3620 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3621 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3622 */
3623
3624/**
3625 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3626 *
3627 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3628 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3629 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3630 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3631 *
3632 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3633 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3634 *	multicast address.
3635 *
3636 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3637 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3638 *
3639 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3640 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3641 *
3642 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3643 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3644 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3645 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3646 *	honour this flag if possible.
3647 *
3648 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3649 *	station
3650 *
3651 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3652 *
3653 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3654 *
3655 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3656 *
3657 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3658 */
3659enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3660	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3661	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3662	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3663	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3664	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3665	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3666	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3667	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3668	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3669};
3670
3671/**
3672 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3673 *
3674 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3675 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3676 *
3677 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3678 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3679 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3680 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3681 *
3682 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3683 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3684 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3685 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3686 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3687 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3688 *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3689 *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3690 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3691 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3692 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3693 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3694 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3695 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3696 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3697 *	session is gone and removes the station.
3698 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3699 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3700 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3701 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3702 */
3703enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3704	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3705	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3706	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3707	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3708	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3709	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3710	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3711};
3712
3713#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3714#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3715
3716/**
3717 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3718 *
3719 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3720 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3721 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3722 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3723 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3724 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3725 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3726 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3727 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3728 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3729 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3730 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3731 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3732 */
3733struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3734	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3735	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3736	u16 tid;
3737	u16 ssn;
3738	u16 buf_size;
3739	bool amsdu;
3740	u16 timeout;
3741};
3742
3743/**
3744 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3745 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3746 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3747 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3748 */
3749enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3750	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3751	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3752};
3753
3754/**
3755 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3756 *
3757 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3758 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3759 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3760 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3761 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3762 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3763 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3764 *	the peer.
3765 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3766 *	by the peer
3767 */
3768enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3769	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3770	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3771	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3772	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3773};
3774
3775/**
3776 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3777 *
3778 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3779 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3780 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3781 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3782 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3783 *
3784 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3785 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3786 *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3787 */
3788enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3789	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3790	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3791};
3792
3793/**
3794 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3795 *
3796 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3797 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3798 *
3799 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3800 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3801 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3802 *	of wowlan configuration)
3803 */
3804enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3805	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3806	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3807};
3808
3809/**
3810 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3811 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3812 *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3813 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3814 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3815 *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3816 *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3817 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3818 *	while just having been associated
3819 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3820 *	Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3821 */
3822struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3823	u16 duration;
3824	u16 subtype;
3825	u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3826	int link_id;
3827};
3828
3829/**
3830 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3831 *
3832 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3833 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3834 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3835 *
3836 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3837 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3838 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3839 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3840 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3841 *	Must be atomic.
3842 *
3843 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3844 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3845 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3846 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3847 *	or zero.
3848 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3849 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3850 *	is added.
3851 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3852 *
3853 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3854 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3855 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3856 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3857 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3858 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3859 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3860 *
3861 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3862 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3863 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3864 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3865 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3866 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3867 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3868 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3869 *	must return 1 from this function.
3870 *
3871 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3872 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3873 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3874 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3875 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3876 *
3877 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3878 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3879 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3880 *	in suspend().
3881 *
3882 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3883 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3884 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3885 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3886 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3887 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3888 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3889 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3890 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3891 *
3892 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3893 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3894 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3895 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3896 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3897 *
3898 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3899 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3900 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3901 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3902 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3903 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3904 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3905 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3906 *
3907 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3908 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3909 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3910 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3911 *
3912 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3913 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3914 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3915 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3916 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3917 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3918 *	can sleep.
3919 *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3920 *	are not implemented.
3921 *
3922 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3923 *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3924 *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3925 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3926 *	The callback can sleep.
3927 *
3928 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3929 *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3930 *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3931 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3932 *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3933 *	non-MLO connections.
3934 *	The callback can sleep.
3935 *
3936 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3937 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3938 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3939 *
3940 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3941 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3942 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3943 *
3944 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3945 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3946 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3947 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3948 *	which flags are changed.
3949 *	This callback can sleep.
3950 *
3951 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3952 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3953 *
3954 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3955 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3956 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3957 *	is enabled.
3958 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3959 *	The callback can sleep.
3960 *
3961 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3962 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3963 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3964 *	The callback must be atomic.
3965 *
3966 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3967 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3968 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3969 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3970 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3971 *
3972 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3973 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3974 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3975 *
3976 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3977 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3978 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3979 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3980 *	that power save is disabled.
3981 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3982 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3983 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3984 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3985 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3986 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3987 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3988 *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3989 *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3990 *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3991 *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3992 *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3993 *	The callback can sleep.
3994 *
3995 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3996 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3997 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3998 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3999 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4000 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4001 *	The callback can sleep.
4002 *
4003 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4004 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
4005 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4006 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4007 *
4008 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4009 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4010 *
4011 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4012 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4013 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4014 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4015 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4016 *
4017 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4018 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4019 *	this notification.
4020 *	The callback can sleep.
4021 *
4022 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4023 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
4024 *	The callback can sleep.
4025 *
4026 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4027 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4028 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4029 *	The callback must be atomic.
4030 *
4031 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4032 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4033 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4034 *	should be set as well.
4035 *	The callback can sleep.
4036 *
4037 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4038 *	The callback can sleep.
4039 *
4040 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4041 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4042 *
4043 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4044 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4045 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4046 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4047 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4048 *	This callback can sleep.
4049 *
4050 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4051 *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4052 *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4053 *
4054 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4055 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4056 *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4057 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4058 *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4059 *
4060 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4061 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4062 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4063 *	callback can sleep.
4064 *
4065 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4066 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4067 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4068 *	callback can sleep.
4069 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4070 *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4071 *
4072 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4073 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4074 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4075 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4076 *
4077 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4078 *	power for the station.
4079 *	This callback can sleep.
4080 *
4081 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4082 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4083 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4084 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4085 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4086 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4087 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4088 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4089 *	The callback can sleep.
4090 *
4091 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4092 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4093 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4094 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4095 *	in @sta_state.
4096 *	The callback can sleep.
4097 *
4098 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4099 *	be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4100 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4101 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4102 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4103 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4104 *	Must be atomic.
4105 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4106 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4107 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4108 *
4109 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4110 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4111 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4112 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4113 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4114 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4115 *	The callback can sleep.
4116 *
4117 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4118 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4119 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4120 *	The callback can sleep.
4121 *
4122 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4123 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4124 *	required function.
4125 *	The callback can sleep.
4126 *
4127 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4128 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4129 *	required function.
4130 *	The callback can sleep.
4131 *
4132 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4133 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4134 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4135 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4136 *	The callback can sleep.
4137 *
4138 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4139 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4140 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4141 *	TSF synchronization.
4142 *	The callback can sleep.
4143 *
4144 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4145 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4146 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4147 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4148 *	The callback can sleep.
4149 *
4150 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4151 *
4152 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4153 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4154 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4155 *	The callback can sleep.
4156 *
4157 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4158 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4159 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4160 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4161 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4162 *
4163 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4164 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4165 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4166 *
4167 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4168 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4169 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4170 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4171 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4172 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4173 *	The callback can sleep.
4174 *
4175 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4176 *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4177 *	The callback can sleep.
4178 *
4179 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4180 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4181 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4182 *	completion of the channel switch.
4183 *
4184 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4185 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4186 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4187 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4188 *
4189 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4190 *
4191 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4192 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4193 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4194 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4195 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4196 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4197 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4198 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4199 *	must be accepted in this case.
4200 *	This callback may sleep.
4201 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4202 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4203 *
4204 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4205 *
4206 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4207 *
4208 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4209 *	queues before entering power save.
4210 *
4211 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4212 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4213 *	The callback can sleep.
4214 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4215 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4216 *	The callback must be atomic.
4217 *
4218 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4219 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4220 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4221 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4222 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4223 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4224 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4225 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4226 *	more-data bit must always be set.
4227 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4228 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4229 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4230 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4231 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4232 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4233 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4234 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4235 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4236 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4237 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4238 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4239 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4240 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4241 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4242 *	This callback must be atomic.
4243 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4244 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4245 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4246 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4247 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4248 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4249 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4250 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4251 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4252 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4253 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4254 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4255 *	This callback must be atomic.
4256 *
4257 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4258 *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4259 *	expected to return a static value.
4260 *
4261 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4262 *
4263 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4264 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4265 *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4266 *	expected to return a static value.
4267 *
4268 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4269 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4270 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4271 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4272 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4273 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4274 *	management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4275 *	to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4276 *	able to synchronize with the GO.
 
 
 
4277 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4278 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4279 *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4280 *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4281 *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4282 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4283 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4284 *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4285 *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4286 *
4287 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4288 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4289 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4290 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4291 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4292 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4293 *	2 * (DTIM period).
4294 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4295 *
4296 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4297 *	This callback may sleep.
4298 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4299 *	This callback may sleep.
4300 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4301 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4302 *	channel context with different settings
4303 *	This callback may sleep.
4304 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4305 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4306 *	This callback may sleep.
4307 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4308 *	unbound from vif.
4309 *	This callback may sleep.
4310 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4311 *	another, as specified in the list of
4312 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4313 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4314 *	This callback may sleep.
4315 *
4316 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4317 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4318 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4319 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4320 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4321 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4322 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4323 *
4324 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4325 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4326 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4327 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4328 *	This callback may sleep.
4329 *
4330 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4331 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4332 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4333 *
4334 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4335 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4336 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4337 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4338 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4339 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4340 *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4341 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4342 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4343 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4344 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4345 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4346 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4347 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4348 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4349 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4350 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4351 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4352 *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4353 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4354 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4355 *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4356 *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4357 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4358 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4359 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4360 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4361 *
4362 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4363 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4364 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4365 *
4366 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4367 *	and hardware limits.
4368 *
4369 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4370 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4371 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4372 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4373 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4374 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4375 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4376 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4377 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4378 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4379 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4380 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4381 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4382 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4383 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4384 *	the function call.
4385 *
4386 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4387 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4388 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4389 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4390 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4391 *
4392 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4393 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4394 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4395 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4396 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4397 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4398 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4399 *	changed parameters.
4400 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4401 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4402 *	this call.
4403 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4404 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4405 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4406 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4407 *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4408 *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4409 *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4410 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4411 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4412 *
4413 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4414 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4415 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4416 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4417 *	This callback may sleep.
4418 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4419 *	This callback may sleep.
4420 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4421 *	4-address mode
4422 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4423 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4424 *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4425 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4426 *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4427 *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4428 *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4429 *	twt structure.
4430 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4431 *	from the peer.
4432 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4433 *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4434 *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4435 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4436 *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4437 *	radar channel.
4438 *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4439 *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4440 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4441 *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4442 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4443 *	supported by the driver.
4444 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4445 *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4446 *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4447 *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4448 *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4449 *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4450 *	This callback can sleep.
4451 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4452 *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4453 *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4454 *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4455 *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4456 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4457 *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4458 *	that.
4459 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4460 *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4461 *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4462 *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4463 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4464 *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4465 *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4466 *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4467 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4468 *      drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4469 *      the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4470 *      interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4471 *      implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4472 *      &enum nl80211_iftype.
4473 */
4474struct ieee80211_ops {
4475	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4476		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4477		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4478	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4479	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4480#ifdef CONFIG_PM
4481	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4482	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4483	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4484#endif
4485	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4486			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4487	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4488				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4489				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4490	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4492	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4493	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4494				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4495				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4496				 u64 changed);
4497	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499				u64 changed);
4500	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4501				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4502				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4503				  u64 changed);
4504
4505	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4507	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4508			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4509
4510	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4512	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4513				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4514				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4515				 u64 multicast);
4516	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4517				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4518				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4519				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4520	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4521		       bool set);
4522	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4523		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4524		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4525	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4526				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4527				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4528				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4529				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4530	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4531			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4532			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4533	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4534					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4535	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4536		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4537	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4539	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4542				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4543	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4545	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4546			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4547			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4548	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4550	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4552	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4553			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4554			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4555	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4556	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4557	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4559	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4560			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4561#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4562	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4564	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4565				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4566				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4567				 struct dentry *dir);
4568	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4569				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4570				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4571				struct dentry *dir);
4572	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4574				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4575				     struct dentry *dir);
4576#endif
4577	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4578			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4579	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4582	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4583			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4584			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4585			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4586	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4587				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4588				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4589	void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4590				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4591				   struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4592				   u32 changed);
4593	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4594				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4595				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4596	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4597			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4598			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4599			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4600	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4601		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4602		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4603		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4604	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4605	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4606			u64 tsf);
4607	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4608			   s64 offset);
4609	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4610	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4611
4612	/**
4613	 * @ampdu_action:
4614	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4615	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4616	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4617	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4618	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4619	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4620	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4621	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4622	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4623	 *
4624	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4625	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4626	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4627	 *
4628	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4629	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4630	 *
4631	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4632	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4633	 * - ``TX:        81``
4634	 *
4635	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4636	 *
4637	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4638	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4639	 * if the session can start immediately.
4640	 *
4641	 * The callback can sleep.
4642	 */
4643	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4644			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4645			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4646	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4647		struct survey_info *survey);
4648	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4649	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4650#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4651	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4652			    void *data, int len);
4653	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4654			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4655			     void *data, int len);
4656#endif
4657	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4658		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4659	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4660			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4661	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4662			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4663			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4664	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4665	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4666
4667	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4668				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4669				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4670				 int duration,
4671				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4672	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4673					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4674	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4675	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4676			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4677	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4678	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4679				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4680	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4681			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4682			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4683
4684	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4685				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4686				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4687				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4688				      bool more_data);
4689	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4691					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4692					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4693					bool more_data);
4694
4695	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4696				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4697	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4698				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4699				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4700	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4701				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4702				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4703
4704	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4705				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4706				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4707	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4708				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4709				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4710
4711	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4712					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4713					     unsigned int link_id);
4714
4715	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4716			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4717	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4719	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4720			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4721			       u32 changed);
4722	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4723				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4724				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4725				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4726	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4727				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4728				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4729				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4730	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4732				  int n_vifs,
4733				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4734
4735	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4736				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4737
4738#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4739	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4740				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4741				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4742#endif
4743	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4744				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4745				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4746	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4747				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4748				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4749
4750	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4751				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4752				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4753	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4754				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4755				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4756	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4757					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4758					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4759
4760	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4761	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4762	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4764	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4765			   int *dbm);
4766
4767	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4768				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4769				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4770				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4771				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4772	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4773					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4774					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4775	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4776					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4777					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4778
4779	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4780			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4781	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4782
4783	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4784			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4785			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4786	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4787			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4788	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4789			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4790			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4791	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4792			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4793			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4794	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4795			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4796			    u8 instance_id);
4797	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4798				       struct sk_buff *head,
4799				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4800	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4801				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4802				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4803	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4804			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4805	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4806			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4807	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4808			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4809			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4810			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4811	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4812				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4813				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4814	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4815				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4816	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4817			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4818	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4819			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4820	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4821				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4823	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4825			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4826	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4827				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4828	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4829				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4830	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4831				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4832				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4833				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4834				     struct net_device_path *path);
4835	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4836				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4837				   u16 active_links);
4838	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4839				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4840				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4841				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4842	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4843				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4844				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4845				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4846	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4847				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4848				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4849	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4850			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4851			    struct net_device *dev,
4852			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4853			    void *type_data);
4854	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4855	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4856			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4857	void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4858				   enum nl80211_iftype type);
4859};
4860
4861/**
4862 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4863 *
4864 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4865 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4866 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4867 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4868 * @priv_data_len.
4869 *
4870 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4871 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4872 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4873 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4874 *
4875 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4876 */
4877struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4878					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4879					   const char *requested_name);
4880
4881/**
4882 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4883 *
4884 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4885 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4886 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4887 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4888 * @priv_data_len.
4889 *
4890 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4891 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4892 *
4893 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4894 */
4895static inline
4896struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4897					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4898{
4899	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4900}
4901
4902/**
4903 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4904 *
4905 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4906 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4907 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4908 *
4909 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4910 *
4911 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4912 */
4913int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4914
4915/**
4916 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4917 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4918 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4919 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4920 */
4921struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4922	int throughput;
4923	int blink_time;
4924};
4925
4926/**
4927 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4928 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4929 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4930 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4931 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4932 */
4933enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4934	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4935	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4936	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4937};
4938
4939#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4940const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4941const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4942const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4943const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4944const char *
4945__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4946				   unsigned int flags,
4947				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4948				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4949#endif
4950/**
4951 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4952 *
4953 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4954 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4955 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4956 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4957 *
4958 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4959 *
4960 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4961 */
4962static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4963{
4964#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4965	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4966#else
4967	return NULL;
4968#endif
4969}
4970
4971/**
4972 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4973 *
4974 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4975 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4976 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4977 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4978 *
4979 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4980 *
4981 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4982 */
4983static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4984{
4985#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4986	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4987#else
4988	return NULL;
4989#endif
4990}
4991
4992/**
4993 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4994 *
4995 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4996 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4997 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4998 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4999 *
5000 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5001 *
5002 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5003 */
5004static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5005{
5006#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5007	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5008#else
5009	return NULL;
5010#endif
5011}
5012
5013/**
5014 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5015 *
5016 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5017 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5018 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5019 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5020 *
5021 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5022 *
5023 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5024 */
5025static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5026{
5027#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5028	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5029#else
5030	return NULL;
5031#endif
5032}
5033
5034/**
5035 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5036 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5037 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5038 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5039 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5040 *
5041 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5042 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5043 *
5044 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5045 */
5046static inline const char *
5047ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5048				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5049				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5050{
5051#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5052	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5053						  blink_table_len);
5054#else
5055	return NULL;
5056#endif
5057}
5058
5059/**
5060 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5061 *
5062 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5063 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5064 *
5065 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5066 */
5067void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5068
5069/**
5070 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5071 *
5072 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5073 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5074 * before calling this function.
5075 *
5076 * @hw: the hardware to free
5077 */
5078void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5079
5080/**
5081 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5082 *
5083 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5084 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5085 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5086 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5087 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5088 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5089 *
5090 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5091 */
5092void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5093
5094/**
5095 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5096 *
5097 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5098 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5099 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5100 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5101 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5102 *
5103 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5104 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5105 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5106 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5107 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5108 *
5109 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5110 *
5111 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5112 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5113 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5114 * @list: the destination list
5115 */
5116void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5117		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5118
5119/**
5120 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5121 *
5122 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5123 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5124 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5125 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5126 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5127 *
5128 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5129 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5130 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5131 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5132 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5133 *
5134 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5135 *
5136 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5137 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5138 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5139 * @napi: the NAPI context
5140 */
5141void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5142		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5143
5144/**
5145 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5146 *
5147 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5148 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5149 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5150 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5151 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5152 *
5153 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5154 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5155 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5156 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5157 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5158 *
5159 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5160 *
5161 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5162 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5163 */
5164static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5165{
5166	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5167}
5168
5169/**
5170 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5171 *
5172 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5173 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5174 *
5175 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5176 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5177 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5178 *
5179 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5180 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5181 */
5182void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5183
5184/**
5185 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5186 *
5187 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5188 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5189 *
5190 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5191 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5192 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5193 *
5194 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5195 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5196 */
5197static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5198				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5199{
5200	local_bh_disable();
5201	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5202	local_bh_enable();
5203}
5204
5205/**
5206 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5207 *
5208 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5209 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5210 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5211 *
5212 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5213 *
5214 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5215 * each other.
5216 *
5217 * @sta: currently connected sta
5218 * @start: start or stop PS
5219 *
5220 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5221 */
5222int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5223
5224/**
5225 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5226 *                                  (in process context)
5227 *
5228 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5229 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5230 * applies.
5231 *
5232 * @sta: currently connected sta
5233 * @start: start or stop PS
5234 *
5235 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5236 */
5237static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5238						  bool start)
5239{
5240	int ret;
5241
5242	local_bh_disable();
5243	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5244	local_bh_enable();
5245
5246	return ret;
5247}
5248
5249/**
5250 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5251 * @sta: currently connected station
5252 *
5253 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5254 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5255 * connected station was received.
5256 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5257 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5258 * be serialized.
5259 */
5260void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5261
5262/**
5263 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5264 * @sta: currently connected station
5265 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5266 *
5267 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5268 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5269 * from a connected station was received.
5270 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5271 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5272 * serialized.
5273 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5274 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5275 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5276 * checks.
5277 */
5278void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5279
5280/*
5281 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5282 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5283 */
5284#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5285
5286/**
5287 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5288 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5289 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5290 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5291 *
5292 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5293 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5294 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5295 *
5296 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5297 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5298 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5299 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5300 *
5301 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5302 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5303 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5304 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5305 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5306 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5307 *
5308 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5309 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5310 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5311 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5312 * use this API.
5313 */
5314void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5315				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5316
5317/**
5318 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5319 *
5320 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5321 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5322 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5323 *
5324 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5325 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5326 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5327 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5328 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5329 */
5330void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5331			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5332			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5333			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5334			    int max_rates);
5335
5336/**
5337 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5338 *
5339 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5340 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5341 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5342 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5343 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5344 * slow stations to starve).
5345 *
5346 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5347 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5348 */
5349void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5350					   u32 thr);
5351
5352/**
5353 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5354 *
5355 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5356 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5357 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5358 *
5359 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5360 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5361 * @info: tx status information
5362 */
5363void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5364			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5365			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5366
5367/**
5368 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5369 *
5370 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5371 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5372 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5373 *
5374 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5375 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5376 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5377 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5378 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5379 *
5380 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5381 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5382 */
5383void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5384			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5385
5386/**
5387 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5388 *
5389 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5390 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5391 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5392 *
5393 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5394 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5395 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5396 *
5397 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5398 * @status: tx status information
5399 */
5400void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5401			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5402
5403/**
5404 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5405 *
5406 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5407 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5408 * specific skbs.
5409 *
5410 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5411 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5412 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5413 *
5414 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5415 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5416 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5417 * @info: tx status information
5418 */
5419static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5420					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5421					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5422{
5423	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5424		.sta = sta,
5425		.info = info,
5426	};
5427
5428	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5429}
5430
5431/**
5432 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5433 *
5434 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5435 *
5436 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5437 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5438 * for a single hardware.
5439 *
5440 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5441 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5442 */
5443static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5444					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5445{
5446	local_bh_disable();
5447	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5448	local_bh_enable();
5449}
5450
5451/**
5452 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5453 *
5454 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5455 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5456 *
5457 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5458 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5459 *
5460 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5461 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5462 */
5463void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5464				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5465
5466/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5467 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5468 *
5469 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5470 * connected STA.
5471 *
5472 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5473 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5474 */
5475void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5476
5477#define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5478
5479/**
5480 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5481 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5482 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5483 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5484 *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5485 *	should be ignored.
5486 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5487 */
5488struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5489	u16 tim_offset;
5490	u16 tim_length;
5491
5492	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5493	u16 mbssid_off;
5494};
5495
5496/**
5497 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5498 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5499 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5500 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5501 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5502 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5503 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5504 *
5505 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5506 * obtain the beacon template.
5507 *
5508 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5509 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5510 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5511 * applicable, the CSA count.
5512 *
5513 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5514 *
5515 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5516 */
5517struct sk_buff *
5518ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5519			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5520			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5521			      unsigned int link_id);
5522
5523/**
5524 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5525 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5526 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5527 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5528 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5529 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5530 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5531 *
5532 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5533 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5534 * requested index.
5535 *
5536 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5537 */
5538struct sk_buff *
5539ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5540					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5541					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5542					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5543
5544/**
5545 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5546 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5547 *
5548 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5549 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5550 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5551 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5552 */
5553struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5554	u8 cnt;
5555	struct {
5556		struct sk_buff *skb;
5557		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5558	} bcn[];
5559};
5560
5561/**
5562 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5563 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5564 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5565 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5566 *
5567 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5568 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5569 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5570 * one multiple BSSID element.
5571 *
5572 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5573 *
5574 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5575 *	%NULL on error.
5576 */
5577struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5578ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5579				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5580				       unsigned int link_id);
5581
5582/**
5583 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5584 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5585 *
5586 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5587 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5588 */
5589void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5590
5591/**
5592 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5593 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5594 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5595 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5596 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5597 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5598 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5599 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5600 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5601 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5602 *
5603 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5604 * obtain the beacon frame.
5605 *
5606 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5607 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5608 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5609 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5610 *
5611 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5612 *
5613 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5614 */
5615struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5616					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5617					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5618					 unsigned int link_id);
5619
5620/**
5621 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5622 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5623 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5624 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5625 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5626 *
5627 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5628 *
5629 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5630 */
5631static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5632						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5633						   unsigned int link_id)
5634{
5635	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5636}
5637
5638/**
5639 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5640 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5641 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5642 *
5643 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5644 * This function is called implicitly when
5645 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5646 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5647 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5648 *
5649 * Return: new countdown value
5650 */
5651u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5652				  unsigned int link_id);
5653
5654/**
5655 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5656 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5657 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5658 *
5659 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5660 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5661 *
5662 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5663 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5664 */
5665void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5666
5667/**
5668 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5669 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5670 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5671 *
5672 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5673 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5674 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5675 */
5676void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5677
5678/**
5679 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5680 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5681 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5682 *
5683 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5684 */
5685bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5686					 unsigned int link_id);
5687
5688/**
5689 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5690 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5691 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5692 *
5693 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5694 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5695 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5696 */
5697void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5698
5699/**
5700 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5701 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5702 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5703 *
5704 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5705 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5706 *
5707 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5708 *
5709 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5710 */
5711struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5712					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5713
5714/**
5715 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5716 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5717 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5718 *
5719 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5720 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5721 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5722 *
5723 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5724 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5725 *
5726 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5727 */
5728struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5729				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5730
5731/**
5732 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5733 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5734 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5735 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5736 *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5737 *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5738 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5739 *	if at all possible
5740 *
5741 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5742 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5743 * BSSID and address is used.
5744 *
5745 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5746 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5747 *
5748 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5749 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5750 *
5751 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5752 */
5753struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5754				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5755				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5756
5757/**
5758 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5759 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5760 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5761 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5762 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5763 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5764 *
5765 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5766 * hardware.
5767 *
5768 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5769 */
5770struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5771				       const u8 *src_addr,
5772				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5773				       size_t tailroom);
5774
5775/**
5776 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5777 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5778 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5779 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5780 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5781 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5782 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5783 *
5784 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5785 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5786 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5787 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5788 */
5789void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5790		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5791		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5792		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5793
5794/**
5795 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5796 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5797 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5798 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5799 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5800 *
5801 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5802 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5803 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5804 *
5805 * Return: The duration.
5806 */
5807__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5808			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5809			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5810
5811/**
5812 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5813 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5814 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5815 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5816 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5817 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5818 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5819 *
5820 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5821 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5822 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5823 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5824 */
5825void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5826			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5827			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5828			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5829			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5830
5831/**
5832 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5833 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5834 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5835 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5836 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5837 *
5838 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5839 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5840 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5841 *
5842 * Return: The duration.
5843 */
5844__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5845				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5846				    size_t frame_len,
5847				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5848
5849/**
5850 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5851 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5852 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5853 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5854 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5855 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5856 *
5857 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5858 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5859 *
5860 * Return: The duration.
5861 */
5862__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5863					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5864					enum nl80211_band band,
5865					size_t frame_len,
5866					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5867
5868/**
5869 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5870 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5871 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5872 *
5873 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5874 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5875 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5876 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5877 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5878 *
5879 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5880 * frames are available.
5881 *
5882 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5883 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5884 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5885 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5886 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5887 * use common code for all beacons.
5888 */
5889struct sk_buff *
5890ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5891
5892/**
5893 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5894 *
5895 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5896 *
5897 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5898 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5899 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5900 */
5901void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5902			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5903
5904/**
5905 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5906 *
5907 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5908 * from the given packet.
5909 *
5910 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5911 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5912 *	with this P1K
5913 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5914 */
5915static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5916					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5917{
5918	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5919	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5920	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5921
5922	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5923}
5924
5925/**
5926 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5927 *
5928 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5929 * and transmitter address.
5930 *
5931 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5932 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5933 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5934 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5935 */
5936void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5937			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5938
5939/**
5940 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5941 *
5942 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5943 * in the packet.
5944 *
5945 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5946 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5947 *	encrypted with this key
5948 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5949 */
5950void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5951			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5952
5953/**
5954 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5955 *
5956 * @pos: start of crypto header
5957 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5958 * @pn: PN to add
5959 *
5960 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5961 * the packet payload)
5962 *
5963 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5964 * point to the crypto header)
5965 */
5966u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5967
5968/**
5969 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5970 *
5971 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5972 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5973 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5974 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5975 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5976 *
5977 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5978 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5979 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5980 *
5981 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5982 * can be done concurrently.
5983 */
5984void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5985			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5986
5987/**
5988 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5989 *
5990 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5991 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5992 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5993 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5994 * @seq: new sequence data
5995 *
5996 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5997 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5998 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5999 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6000 *
6001 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6002 * can be done concurrently.
6003 */
6004void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6005			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6006
6007/**
6008 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
6009 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6010 *
6011 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6012 *
6013 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
6014 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
6015 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
 
 
 
6016 */
6017void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6018
6019/**
6020 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6021 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6022 * @keyconf: new key data
6023 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6024 *
6025 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6026 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6027 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6028 *
6029 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6030 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6031 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6032 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6033 *
6034 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6035 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6036 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6037 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6038 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6039 * of the reconfiguration.
6040 *
6041 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6042 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6043 *
6044 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6045 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6046 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6047 * the key that's being replaced.
6048 */
6049struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6050ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6051			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6052			int link_id);
6053
6054/**
6055 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6056 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6057 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6058 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6059 * @gfp: allocation flags
6060 */
6061void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6062				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6063
6064/**
6065 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6066 *
6067 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6068 * at the same time.
6069 *
6070 * @keyconf: the key in question
6071 */
6072void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6073
6074/**
6075 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6076 *
6077 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6078 * at the same time.
6079 *
6080 * @keyconf: the key in question
6081 */
6082void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6083
6084/**
6085 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6086 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6087 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6088 *
6089 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6090 */
6091void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6092
6093/**
6094 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6095 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6096 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6097 *
6098 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6099 */
6100void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6101
6102/**
6103 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6104 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6105 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6106 *
6107 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6108 *
6109 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6110 */
6111
6112int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6113
6114/**
6115 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6116 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6117 *
6118 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6119 */
6120void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6121
6122/**
6123 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6124 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6125 *
6126 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6127 */
6128void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6129
6130/**
6131 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6132 *
6133 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6134 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6135 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6136 * any context, including hardirq context.
6137 *
6138 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6139 * @info: information about the completed scan
6140 */
6141void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6142			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6143
6144/**
6145 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6146 *
6147 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6148 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6149 *
6150 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6151 */
6152void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6153
6154/**
6155 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6156 *
6157 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6158 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6159 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6160 * while associating, for instance.
6161 *
6162 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6163 */
6164void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6165
6166/**
6167 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6168 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6169 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6170 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6171 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6172 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6173 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6174 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6175 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6176 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6177 *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6178 *	for instance.
6179 */
6180enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6181	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6182	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6183	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6184	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6185};
6186
6187/**
6188 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6189 *
6190 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6191 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6192 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6193 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6194 *
6195 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6196 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6197 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6198 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6199 */
6200void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6201				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6202						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6203				  void *data);
6204
6205/**
6206 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6207 *
6208 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6209 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6210 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6211 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6212 * be used.
6213 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6214 *
6215 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6216 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6217 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6218 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6219 */
6220static inline void
6221ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6222				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6223						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6224				    void *data)
6225{
6226	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6227				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6228				     iterator, data);
6229}
6230
6231/**
6232 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6233 *
6234 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6235 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6236 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6237 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6238 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6239 *
6240 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6241 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6242 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6243 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6244 */
6245void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6246						u32 iter_flags,
6247						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6248						    u8 *mac,
6249						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6250						void *data);
6251
6252/**
6253 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6254 *
6255 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6256 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6257 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
 
 
 
6258 *
6259 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6260 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6261 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6262 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6263 */
6264void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6265					     u32 iter_flags,
6266					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6267						u8 *mac,
6268						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6269					     void *data);
6270
6271/**
6272 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6273 *
6274 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6275 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6276 * function for them.
6277 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
 
6278 *
6279 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6280 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6281 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6282 */
6283void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6284				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6285						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6286				       void *data);
6287
6288/**
6289 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6290 *
6291 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6292 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6293 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6294 * mutex.
6295 *
6296 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6297 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6298 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6299 */
6300void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6301				    void (*iterator)(void *data,
6302						     struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6303				    void *data);
6304
6305/**
6306 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6307 *
6308 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6309 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6310 *
6311 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6312 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6313 */
6314void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6315
6316/**
6317 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6318 *
6319 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6320 * workqueue.
6321 *
6322 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6323 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6324 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6325 */
6326void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6327				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6328				  unsigned long delay);
6329
6330/**
6331 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6332 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6333 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6334 *
6335 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6336 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6337 * mac80211.
6338 *
6339 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6340 */
6341void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6342					    u16 tid);
6343
6344/**
6345 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6346 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6347 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6348 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6349 *
6350 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6351 *
6352 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6353 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6354 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6355 */
6356int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6357				  u16 timeout);
6358
6359/**
6360 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6361 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6362 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6363 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6364 *
6365 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6366 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6367 * from any context.
6368 */
6369void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6370				      u16 tid);
6371
6372/**
6373 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6374 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6375 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6376 *
6377 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6378 *
6379 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6380 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6381 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6382 */
6383int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6384
6385/**
6386 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6387 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6388 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6389 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6390 *
6391 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6392 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6393 * can be called from any context.
6394 */
6395void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6396				     u16 tid);
6397
6398/**
6399 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6400 *
6401 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6402 * @addr: station's address
6403 *
6404 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6405 *
6406 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6407 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6408 */
6409struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6410					 const u8 *addr);
6411
6412/**
6413 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6414 *
6415 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6416 * @addr: remote station's address
6417 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6418 *
6419 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6420 *
6421 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6422 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6423 *
6424 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6425 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6426 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6427 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6428 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6429 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6430 *      is not reliable.
6431 *
6432 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6433 */
6434struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6435					       const u8 *addr,
6436					       const u8 *localaddr);
6437
6438/**
6439 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6440 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6441 * @addr: remote station's link address
6442 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6443 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6444 *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6445 *
6446 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6447 *
6448 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6449 */
6450struct ieee80211_sta *
6451ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6452				 const u8 *addr,
6453				 const u8 *localaddr,
6454				 unsigned int *link_id);
6455
6456/**
6457 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6458 * @hw: the hardware
6459 * @pubsta: the station
6460 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6461 *
6462 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6463 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6464 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6465 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6466 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6467 *
6468 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6469 * manner.
6470 *
6471 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6472 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6473 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6474 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6475 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6476 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6477 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6478 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6479 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6480 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6481 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6482 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6483 * woke up while blocked or not.
6484 */
6485void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6486			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6487
6488/**
6489 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6490 * @pubsta: the station
6491 *
6492 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6493 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6494 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6495 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6496 *
6497 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6498 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6499 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6500 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6501 *
6502 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6503 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6504 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6505 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6506 */
6507void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6508
6509/**
6510 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6511 * @pubsta: the station
6512 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6513 *
6514 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6515 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6516 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6517 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6518 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6519 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6520 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6521 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6522 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6523 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6524 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6525 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6526 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6527 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6528 */
6529void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6530
6531/**
6532 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6533 * @pubsta: the station
6534 *
6535 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6536 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6537 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6538 *
6539 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6540 * there is no need to call this function.
6541 */
6542void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6543
6544/**
6545 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6546 *
6547 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6548 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6549 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6550 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6551 *
6552 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6553 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6554 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6555 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6556 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6557 * attempts.
6558 *
6559 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6560 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6561 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6562 * them to 0.
6563 *
6564 * @pubsta: the station
6565 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6566 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6567 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6568 */
6569void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6570				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6571
6572/**
6573 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6574 *
6575 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6576 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6577 *
6578 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6579 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6580 */
6581bool
6582ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6583
6584/**
6585 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6586 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6587 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6588 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6589 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6590 *
6591 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6592 *
6593 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6594 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6595 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6596 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
 
 
6597 *
6598 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6599 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6600 * set_key callback.
6601 */
6602void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6603			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6604			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6605				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6606				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6607				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6608				      void *data),
6609			 void *iter_data);
6610
6611/**
6612 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6613 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6614 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6615 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6616 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6617 *
6618 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6619 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6620 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6621 * in removal process will be skipped.
6622 *
6623 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6624 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6625 */
6626void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6627			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6628			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6629					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6630					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6631					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6632					  void *data),
6633			     void *iter_data);
6634
6635/**
6636 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6637 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6638 * @iter: iterator function
6639 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6640 *
6641 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6642 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6643 * places while calling into the driver.
6644 *
6645 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6646 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6647 * removed.
6648 *
6649 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6650 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6651 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6652 * or not.
6653 */
6654void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6655	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6656	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6657		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6658		     void *data),
6659	void *iter_data);
6660
6661/**
6662 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6663 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6664 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6665 *
6666 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6667 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6668 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6669 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6670 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6671 * %NULL.
6672 *
6673 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6674 */
6675struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6676					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6677
6678/**
6679 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6680 *
6681 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6682 *
6683 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6684 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6685 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6686 */
6687void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6688
6689/**
6690 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6691 *
6692 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6693 *
6694 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6695 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6696 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6697 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6698 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6699 *
6700 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6701 * without connection recovery attempts.
6702 */
6703void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6704
6705/**
6706 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6707 *
6708 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6709 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6710 *
6711 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6712 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6713 */
6714void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6715
6716/**
6717 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6718 *
6719 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6720 *
6721 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6722 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6723 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6724 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6725 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6726 *
6727 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6728 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6729 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6730 * disconnect normally later.
6731 *
6732 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6733 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6734 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6735 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6736 */
6737void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6738
6739/**
6740 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6741 * hardware restart
6742 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6743 *
6744 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6745 * hardware restart.
6746 */
6747void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6748
6749/**
6750 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6751 *	rssi threshold triggered
6752 *
6753 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6754 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6755 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6756 * @gfp: context flags
6757 *
6758 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6759 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6760 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6761 */
6762void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6763			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6764			       s32 rssi_level,
6765			       gfp_t gfp);
6766
6767/**
6768 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6769 *
6770 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6771 * @gfp: context flags
6772 */
6773void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6774
6775/**
6776 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6777 *
6778 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6779 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6780 *	pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6781 */
6782void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6783			      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6784
6785/**
6786 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6787 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6788 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6789 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6790 *	false.
6791 *
6792 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6793 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6794 */
6795void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6796			     unsigned int link_id);
6797
6798/**
6799 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6800 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
6801 *
6802 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6803 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6804 * a deauth frame in this case.
6805 */
6806void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
6807
6808/**
6809 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6810 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6811 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6812 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6813 *
6814 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6815 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6816 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6817 */
6818void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6819			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6820
6821/**
6822 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6823 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6824 */
6825void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6826
6827/**
6828 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6829 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6830 */
6831void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6832
6833/**
6834 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6835 *
6836 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6837 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6838 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6839 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6840 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6841 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6842 *
6843 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6844 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6845 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6846 */
6847void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6848				  const u8 *addr);
6849
6850/**
6851 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6852 * @pubsta: station struct
6853 * @tid: the session's TID
6854 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6855 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6856 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6857 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6858 *
6859 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6860 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6861 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6862 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6863 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6864 */
6865void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6866					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6867					  u16 received_mpdus);
6868
6869/**
6870 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6871 *
6872 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6873 * buffer.
6874 *
6875 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6876 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6877 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6878 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6879 */
6880void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6881
6882/**
6883 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6884 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6885 * @addr: station mac address
6886 * @tid: the rx tid
6887 */
6888void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6889				 unsigned int tid);
6890
6891/**
6892 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6893 *
6894 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6895 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6896 * reordering.
6897 *
6898 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6899 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6900 *
6901 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6902 * @addr: station mac address
6903 * @tid: the rx tid
6904 */
6905static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6906						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6907{
6908	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6909		return;
6910	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6911}
6912
6913/**
6914 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6915 *
6916 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6917 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6918 * reordering.
6919 *
6920 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6921 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6922 *
6923 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6924 * @addr: station mac address
6925 * @tid: the rx tid
6926 */
6927static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6928						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6929{
6930	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6931		return;
6932	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6933}
6934
6935/**
6936 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6937 *
6938 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6939 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6940 *
6941 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6942 *
6943 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6944 * @addr: station mac address
6945 * @tid: the rx tid
6946 */
6947void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6948				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6949
6950/* Rate control API */
6951
6952/**
6953 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6954 *
6955 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6956 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6957 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6958 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6959 *	to be filled in
6960 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6961 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6962 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6963 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6964 *	RTS threshold
6965 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6966 *	if the selected rate supports it
6967 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6968 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6969 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6970 */
6971struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6972	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6973	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6974	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6975	struct sk_buff *skb;
6976	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6977	bool rts, short_preamble;
6978	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6979	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6980	bool bss;
6981};
6982
6983/**
6984 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6985 */
6986enum rate_control_capabilities {
6987	/**
6988	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6989	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6990	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6991	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6992	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6993	 */
6994	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6995	/**
6996	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6997	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6998	 */
6999	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7000};
7001
7002struct rate_control_ops {
7003	unsigned long capa;
7004	const char *name;
7005	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7006	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7007			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7008	void (*free)(void *priv);
7009
7010	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7011	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7012			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7013			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7014	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7015			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7016			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7017			    u32 changed);
7018	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7019			 void *priv_sta);
7020
7021	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7022			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7023			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7024	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7025			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7026			  struct sk_buff *skb);
7027	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7028			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7029
7030	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7031				struct dentry *dir);
7032
7033	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7034};
7035
7036static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7037				 enum nl80211_band band,
7038				 int index)
7039{
7040	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7041}
7042
7043static inline s8
7044rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7045		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7046{
7047	int i;
7048
7049	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7050		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7051			return i;
7052
7053	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7054	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7055
7056	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7057	return 0;
7058}
7059
7060static inline
7061bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7062			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7063{
7064	unsigned int i;
7065
7066	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7067		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7068			return true;
7069	return false;
7070}
7071
7072/**
7073 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7074 *
7075 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7076 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7077 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7078 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7079 *
7080 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7081 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7082 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7083 *
7084 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7085 */
7086int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7087			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7088			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7089
7090int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7091void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7092
7093static inline bool
7094conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7095{
7096	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7097}
7098
7099static inline bool
7100conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7101{
7102	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7103	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7104}
7105
7106static inline bool
7107conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7108{
7109	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7110	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7111}
7112
7113static inline bool
7114conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7115{
7116	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7117}
7118
7119static inline bool
7120conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7121{
7122	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7123		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7124		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7125}
7126
7127static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7128ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7129{
7130	if (p2p) {
7131		switch (type) {
7132		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7133			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7134		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7135			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7136		default:
7137			break;
7138		}
7139	}
7140	return type;
7141}
7142
7143static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7144ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7145{
7146	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7147}
7148
7149/**
7150 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7151 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7152 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7153 *
7154 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7155 */
7156static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
7157ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7158				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7159{
7160	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7161}
7162
7163/**
7164 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7165 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7166 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7167 *
7168 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7169 */
7170static inline __le16
7171ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7172			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7173{
7174	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7175}
7176
7177/**
7178 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7179 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7180 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7181 *
7182 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7183 */
7184static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
7185ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7186				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7187{
7188	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7189}
7190
7191/**
7192 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7193 *
7194 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7195 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7196 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7197 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7198 *
7199 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7200 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7201 * matching GroupId management frame.
7202 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7203 */
7204void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7205				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7206
7207void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7208				   int rssi_min_thold,
7209				   int rssi_max_thold);
7210
7211void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7212
7213/**
7214 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7215 *
7216 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7217 *
7218 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7219 *
7220 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7221 * applicable.
7222 */
7223int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7224
7225/**
7226 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7227 * @vif: virtual interface
7228 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7229 * @gfp: allocation flags
7230 *
7231 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7232 */
7233void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7234				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7235				    gfp_t gfp);
7236
7237/**
7238 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7239 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7240 * @vif: virtual interface
7241 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7242 * @band: the band to transmit on
7243 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7244 *
7245 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7246 *
7247 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7248 */
7249bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7250			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7251			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7252
7253/**
7254 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7255 *				 of injected frames.
7256 *
7257 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7258 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7259 * of the skb before calling this function.
7260 *
7261 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7262 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7263 *
7264 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7265 */
7266bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7267				 struct net_device *dev);
7268
7269/**
7270 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7271 *
7272 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7273 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7274 *
7275 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7276 *
7277 * private:
7278 *
7279 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7280 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7281 */
7282struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7283	u32 next_tsf;
7284	bool has_next_tsf;
7285
7286	u8 absent;
7287
7288	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7289	struct {
7290		u32 start;
7291		u32 duration;
7292		u32 interval;
7293	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7294};
7295
7296/**
7297 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7298 *
7299 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7300 * @data: NoA tracking data
7301 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7302 *
7303 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7304 */
7305int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7306			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7307
7308/**
7309 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7310 *
7311 * @data: NoA tracking data
7312 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7313 */
7314void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7315
7316/**
7317 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7318 * @vif: virtual interface
7319 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7320 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7321 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7322 * @gfp: allocation flags
7323 *
7324 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7325 */
7326void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7327				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7328				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7329
7330/**
7331 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7332 *
7333 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7334 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7335 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7336 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7337 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7338 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7339 *
7340 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7341 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7342 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7343 *
7344 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7345 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7346 *
7347 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7348 */
7349int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7350
7351/**
7352 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7353 *
7354 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7355 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7356 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7357 *
7358 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7359 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7360 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7361 *
7362 * @sta: the station
7363 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7364 */
7365void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7366
7367/**
7368 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7369 *
7370 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7371 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7372 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7373 *
7374 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7375 *
7376 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7377 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7378 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7379 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7380 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7381 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7382 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7383 *
7384 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7385 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7386 */
7387struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7388				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7389
7390/**
7391 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7392 * (in process context)
7393 *
7394 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7395 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7396 *
7397 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7398 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7399 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7400 *
7401 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7402 */
7403static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7404						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7405{
7406	struct sk_buff *skb;
7407
7408	local_bh_disable();
7409	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7410	local_bh_enable();
7411
7412	return skb;
7413}
7414
7415/**
7416 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7417 *
7418 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7419 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7420 *
7421 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7422 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7423 */
7424void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7425				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7426
7427/**
7428 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7429 *
7430 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7431 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7432 *
7433 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7434 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7435 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7436 */
7437struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7438
7439/**
7440 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7441 *
7442 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7443 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7444 *
7445 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7446 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7447 */
7448void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7449
7450/* (deprecated) */
7451static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7452{
7453}
7454
7455void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7456			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7457
7458/**
7459 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7460 *
7461 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7462 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7463 *
7464 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7465 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7466 *
7467 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7468 * this TXQ internally.
7469 */
7470static inline void
7471ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7472{
7473	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7474}
7475
7476/**
7477 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7478 *
7479 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7480 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7481 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7482 *
7483 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7484 * internally.
7485 */
7486static inline void
7487ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7488		     bool force)
7489{
7490	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7491}
7492
7493/**
7494 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7495 *
7496 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7497 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7498 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7499 * next_txq().
7500 *
7501 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7502 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7503 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7504 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7505 * again.
7506 *
7507 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7508 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7509 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7510 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7511 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7512 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7513 *
7514 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7515 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7516 *
7517 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7518 */
7519bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7520				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7521
7522/**
7523 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7524 *
7525 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7526 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7527 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7528 *
7529 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7530 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7531 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7532 */
7533void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7534			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7535			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7536
7537/**
7538 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7539 *
7540 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7541 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7542 *
7543 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7544 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7545 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7546 * @gfp: allocation flags
7547 */
7548void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7549				   u8 inst_id,
7550				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7551				   gfp_t gfp);
7552
7553/**
7554 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7555 *
7556 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7557 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7558 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7559 *
7560 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7561 * @match: match event information
7562 * @gfp: allocation flags
7563 */
7564void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7565			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7566			      gfp_t gfp);
7567
7568/**
7569 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7570 *
7571 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7572 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7573 *
7574 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7575 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7576 *          information.
7577 * @len: frame length in bytes
7578 *
7579 * Return: the airtime estimate
7580 */
7581u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7582			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7583			      int len);
7584
7585/**
7586 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7587 *
7588 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7589 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7590 *
7591 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7592 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7593 * @len: frame length in bytes
7594 *
7595 * Return: the airtime estimate
7596 */
7597u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7598			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7599			      int len);
7600/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7601 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7602 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7603 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7604 *
7605 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7606 *
7607 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7608 */
7609struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7610						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7611
7612/**
7613 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7614 *	probe response template.
7615 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7616 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7617 *
7618 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7619 *
7620 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7621 */
7622struct sk_buff *
7623ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7624					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7625
7626/**
7627 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7628 * collision.
7629 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7630 *
7631 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7632 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7633 *	aware of.
 
7634 */
7635void
7636ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7637				      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7638
7639/**
7640 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7641 *
7642 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7643 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7644 *
7645 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7646 *
7647 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7648 */
7649static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7650{
7651	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7652	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7653
7654	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7655	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7656}
7657
7658/**
7659 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7660 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7661 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7662 *
7663 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7664 *	back into the driver.
7665 *
7666 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7667 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7668 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7669 *
7670 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7671 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7672 * a sequence of calls like
7673 *
7674 *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7675 *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7676 *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7677 *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7678 *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7679 *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7680 *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7681 *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
 
7682 *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7683 *
7684 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
 
 
7685 */
7686int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7687
7688/**
7689 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7690 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7691 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7692 *
7693 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7694 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7695 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7696 * completed after it returns.
7697 */
7698void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7699				      u16 active_links);
7700
7701/**
7702 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7703 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7704 *
7705 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7706 * TTLM request.
7707 */
7708void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7709
7710/**
7711 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7712 * @width: the channel width value to convert
7713 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7714 */
7715static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
7716ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7717{
7718	switch (width) {
7719	default:
7720		WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7721		fallthrough;
7722	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7723	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7724		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7725	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7726		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7727	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7728		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7729	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7730	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7731		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7732	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7733		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7734	}
7735}
7736
7737/* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7738int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7739				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7740void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7741				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7742void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7743				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7744				      u32 changed);
7745int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7746					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7747					 int n_vifs,
7748					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7749
7750#endif /* MAC80211_H */
v6.2
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2/*
   3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   4 *
   5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   6 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   7 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
  16#include <linux/bug.h>
  17#include <linux/kernel.h>
  18#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  19#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  20#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  21#include <linux/lockdep.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  23#include <net/codel.h>
  24#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
  25#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  26
  27/**
  28 * DOC: Introduction
  29 *
  30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  33 * drivers.
  34 */
  35
  36/**
  37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  38 *
  39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  44 * tasklet function.
  45 *
  46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  47 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  48 */
  49
  50/**
  51 * DOC: Warning
  52 *
  53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  55 */
  56
  57/**
  58 * DOC: Frame format
  59 *
  60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  63 * hardware.
  64 *
  65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  66 *
  67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  69 *
  70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  72 */
  73
  74/**
  75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  76 *
  77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  81 *
  82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  83 * suspend.
  84 *
  85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  86 *
  87 */
  88
  89/**
  90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  91 *
  92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
  93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
  94 * different stations/interfaces.
  95 *
  96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
  97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
  98 * handler.
  99 *
 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 103 *
 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 106 *
 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
 109 * driver op.
 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
 113 *
 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 119 *
 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 124 * .release_buffered_frames().
 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 128 */
 129
 130/**
 131 * DOC: HW timestamping
 132 *
 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
 135 *
 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
 140 *
 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
 145 */
 146struct device;
 147
 148/**
 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 150 *
 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 153 */
 154enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 155	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 156	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 157};
 158
 159#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 160
 161/**
 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 167 */
 168enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 169	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 170	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 171	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 172	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 173};
 174
 175/**
 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 177 *
 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 180 *
 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 183 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 190 */
 191struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 192	u16 txop;
 193	u16 cw_min;
 194	u16 cw_max;
 195	u8 aifs;
 196	bool acm;
 197	bool uapsd;
 198	bool mu_edca;
 199	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
 200};
 201
 202struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 203	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 204	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 205	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 206	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 207};
 208
 209/**
 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 215 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 
 
 
 
 217 */
 218enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 219	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 220	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 221	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 222	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 223	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 224};
 225
 226/**
 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 228 *
 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 231 *
 232 * @def: the channel definition
 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 
 
 
 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 235 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 237 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 238 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 241 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 242 */
 243struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 244	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 245	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 
 246
 
 247	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 248
 249	bool radar_enabled;
 250
 251	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 252};
 253
 254/**
 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 257 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 258 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 260 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 261 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 262 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 263 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 264 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 265 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 266 *      for changes/removal.)
 267 */
 268enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 269	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 270	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 271};
 272
 273/**
 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 275 *
 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 279 * done.
 280 *
 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 285 */
 286struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 287	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 288	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
 289	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 290	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 291};
 292
 293/**
 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 295 *
 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
 298 *
 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 300 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 308 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 310 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 312 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 317 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 324 *	changed
 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 326 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 328 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 329 *	context had been assigned.
 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 333 *	keep alive) changed.
 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 336 *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 342 *	status changed.
 343 *
 
 
 344 */
 345enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 346	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 347	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 348	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 349	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 350	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 351	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 352	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 353	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 354	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 355	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 356	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 357	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 358	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 359	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 360	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 361	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 362	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 363	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 364	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 365	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 366	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 367	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 368	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 369	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 370	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 371	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 372	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
 373	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
 374	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
 375	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
 376	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
 377	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
 
 
 
 378
 379	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 380};
 381
 382/*
 383 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 384 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 385 * filtering will be disabled.
 386 */
 387#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 388
 389/**
 390 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 391 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 392 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 393 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 394 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 395 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 396 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 397 */
 398enum ieee80211_event_type {
 399	RSSI_EVENT,
 400	MLME_EVENT,
 401	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 402	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 403};
 404
 405/**
 406 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 407 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 409 */
 410enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 411	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 412	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 413};
 414
 415/**
 416 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 417 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 418 */
 419struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 420	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 421};
 422
 423/**
 424 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 425 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 426 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 427 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 428 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 429 */
 430enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 431	AUTH_EVENT,
 432	ASSOC_EVENT,
 433	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 434	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 435};
 436
 437/**
 438 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 439 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 440 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 441 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 442 */
 443enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 444	MLME_SUCCESS,
 445	MLME_DENIED,
 446	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 447};
 448
 449/**
 450 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 451 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 452 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 453 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 454 */
 455struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 456	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 457	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 458	u16 reason;
 459};
 460
 461/**
 462 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 463 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 464 * @tid: the tid
 465 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 466 */
 467struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 468	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 469	u16 tid;
 470	u16 ssn;
 471};
 472
 473/**
 474 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 475 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 476 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 477 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 478 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 479 * @u:union holding the fields above
 480 */
 481struct ieee80211_event {
 482	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 483	union {
 484		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 485		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 486		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 487	} u;
 488};
 489
 490/**
 491 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 492 *
 493 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 494 *
 495 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 496 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 497 */
 498struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 499	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 500	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 501};
 502
 503/**
 504 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 505 *
 506 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 507 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 508 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 509 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 510 */
 511struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
 512	const u8 *lci;
 513	const u8 *civicloc;
 514	size_t lci_len;
 515	size_t civicloc_len;
 516};
 517
 518/**
 519 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
 520 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
 521 *
 522 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 523 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 524 */
 525struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
 526	u32 min_interval;
 527	u32 max_interval;
 528};
 529
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 530/**
 531 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 532 *
 533 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 534 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 535 *
 
 
 
 
 
 536 * @addr: (link) address used locally
 537 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
 538 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 539 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 540 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
 541 *	ACK, BACK or both
 542 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 543 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 544 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 545 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 546 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 547 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 548 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 549 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 550 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
 551 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 552 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 553 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 554 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 555 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 556 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 557 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 558 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 559 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 560 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 561 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 562 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 563 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 564 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 565 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 566 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 567 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 568 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 569 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 570 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 571 *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
 572 *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
 573 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 574 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 575 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 576 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 577 *	the current band.
 578 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 579 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 580 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 581 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 582 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 583 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 584 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 585 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 586 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 587 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 588 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 589 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 590 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 591 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 592 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 593 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 594 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 595 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 596 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 597 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 598 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 599 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 600 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 601 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 602 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 603 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 604 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 605 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 606 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 607 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 608 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 609 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 610 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 611 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 612 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 613 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 614 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 615 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 616 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 617 *	station.
 618 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 619 *	responder functionality.
 620 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 621 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 622 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 623 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 624 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 625 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 626 *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
 627 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 628 *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 629 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
 630 *	connected to (STA)
 631 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 632 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 633 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
 634 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 635 *	interval.
 636 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
 637 *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
 638 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
 639 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
 640 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
 641 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
 642 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
 643 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
 644 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
 645 *	for read access.
 646 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
 647 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
 648 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
 649 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
 650 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
 651 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
 652 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
 653 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
 654 *	for read access.
 655 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 656 */
 657struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 
 
 
 658	const u8 *bssid;
 659	unsigned int link_id;
 660	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
 661	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
 662	bool uora_exists;
 663	u8 uora_ocw_range;
 664	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
 665	bool he_support;
 666	bool twt_requester;
 667	bool twt_responder;
 668	bool twt_protected;
 669	bool twt_broadcast;
 670	/* erp related data */
 671	bool use_cts_prot;
 672	bool use_short_preamble;
 673	bool use_short_slot;
 674	bool enable_beacon;
 675	u8 dtim_period;
 676	u16 beacon_int;
 677	u16 assoc_capability;
 678	u64 sync_tsf;
 679	u32 sync_device_ts;
 680	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 681	u32 basic_rates;
 682	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 683	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 684	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 685	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 686	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 687	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 688	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 689	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
 690	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 691	bool qos;
 692	bool hidden_ssid;
 693	int txpower;
 694	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 695	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 696	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 697	u16 max_idle_period;
 698	bool protected_keep_alive;
 699	bool ftm_responder;
 700	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
 701	/* Multiple BSSID data */
 702	bool nontransmitted;
 703	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
 704	u8 bssid_index;
 705	u8 bssid_indicator;
 706	bool ema_ap;
 707	u8 profile_periodicity;
 708	struct {
 709		u32 params;
 710		u16 nss_set;
 711	} he_oper;
 712	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
 713	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 714	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
 715	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
 716	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
 717	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
 718	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
 719	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
 
 720	u8 pwr_reduction;
 721	bool eht_support;
 722
 723	bool csa_active;
 
 724	bool mu_mimo_owner;
 725	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
 726
 727	bool color_change_active;
 728	u8 color_change_color;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 729};
 730
 731/**
 732 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 733 *
 734 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 735 *
 736 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 737 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 738 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 739 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 740 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 741 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 742 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 743 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 744 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 745 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 746 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 747 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 748 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 749 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 750 *	station
 751 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 752 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 753 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 754 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 755 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 756 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 757 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 758 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 759 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 760 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 761 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 762 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 763 *	hardware queue.
 764 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 765 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 766 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 767 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 768 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 769 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 770 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 771 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 772 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 773 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 774 *	off-channel operation.
 775 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 776 *	(header conversion)
 777 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 778 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 779 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 780 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 781 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 782 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 783 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 784 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 785 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 786 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 787 *	queue gets full.
 788 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 789 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 790 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 791 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 792 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 793 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 794 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 795 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 796 *	status to user space)
 797 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 799 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 800 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 801 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 802 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 803 *	handled properly by the device.
 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 805 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 806 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 807 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 808 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 809 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 810 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 811 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 812 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 813 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 814 *	PS-Poll responses.
 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 816 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 817 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 818 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 819 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 820 *	monitor injection).
 821 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 822 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 823 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 824 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 825 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 826 *
 827 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 828 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 829 */
 830enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 831	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 832	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 833	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 834	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 835	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 836	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 837	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 838	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 839	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 840	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 841	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 842	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 843	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 844	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 845	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
 846	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 847	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 848	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 849	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 850	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 851	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 852	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 853	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 854	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 855	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 856	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 857	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 858	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 859	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 860	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 861	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 862};
 863
 864#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 865
 866#define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
 867
 868/**
 869 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 870 *
 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 872 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 873 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 874 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 875 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 876 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 877 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 878 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
 879 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 880 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 881 *	it can be sent out.
 882 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
 883 *	has already been assigned to this frame.
 884 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
 885 *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
 886 *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
 887 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
 888 *	for sequence number assignment
 
 
 
 889 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
 890 *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
 891 *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
 892 *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
 893 *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
 894 *	it's intended for an MLD.
 895 *
 896 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 897 */
 898enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 899	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 900	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 901	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 902	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 903	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 904	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
 905	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
 906	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
 907	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
 908	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
 
 909	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
 910};
 911
 912#define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
 913#define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
 914	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
 915			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
 916
 917/**
 918 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
 919 *
 920 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
 921 *
 922 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
 923 */
 924enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
 925	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
 926};
 927
 928/*
 929 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 930 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 931 */
 932#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 933	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 934	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 935	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 936	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 937	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
 938	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 939	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 940
 941/**
 942 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 943 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 944 *
 945 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 946 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 947 *
 948 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 949 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 950 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 951 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 952 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 953 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
 954 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
 955 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 956 *	Greenfield mode.
 957 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 958 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
 959 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
 960 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
 961 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 962 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 963 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 964 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 965 */
 966enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 967	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 968	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 969	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 970
 971	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
 972	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 973	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 974	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 975	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 976	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 977	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
 978	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
 979	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
 980};
 981
 982
 983/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 984#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 985
 986/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 987#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 988
 989/* maximum number of rate stages */
 990#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
 991
 992/* maximum number of rate table entries */
 993#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
 994
 995/**
 996 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 997 *
 998 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 999 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1000 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1001 *
1002 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1003 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1004 *
1005 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1006 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1007 *
1008 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1009 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1010 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1011 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1012 * information::
1013 *
1014 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1015 *
1016 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1017 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1018 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1019 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1020 * information should then contain::
1021 *
1022 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1023 *
1024 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1025 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1026 */
1027struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1028	s8 idx;
1029	u16 count:5,
1030	    flags:11;
1031} __packed;
1032
1033#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1034
 
 
 
 
 
1035static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1036					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1037{
1038	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1039	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1040	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1041}
1042
1043static inline u8
1044ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1045{
1046	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1047}
1048
1049static inline u8
1050ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1051{
1052	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1053}
1054
1055/**
1056 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1057 *
1058 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1059 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1060 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1061 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1062 *
1063 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1064 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1065 *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1066 *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1067 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1068 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
 
 
1069 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1070 * @control: union part for control data
1071 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1072 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1073 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1074 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1075 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1076 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1077 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1078 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1079 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1080 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1081 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1082 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1083 * @pad: padding
1084 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1085 * @status: union part for status data
1086 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1087 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1088 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1089 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1090 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1091 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1092 *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1093 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1094 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1095 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1096 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1097 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1098 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1099 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1100 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1101 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1102 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1103 */
1104struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1105	/* common information */
1106	u32 flags;
1107	u32 band:3,
1108	    ack_frame_id:13,
 
1109	    hw_queue:4,
1110	    tx_time_est:10;
1111	/* 2 free bits */
1112
1113	union {
1114		struct {
1115			union {
1116				/* rate control */
1117				struct {
1118					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1119						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1120					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1121					u8 use_rts:1;
1122					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1123					u8 short_preamble:1;
1124					u8 skip_table:1;
1125					/* 2 bytes free */
 
 
 
 
1126				};
1127				/* only needed before rate control */
1128				unsigned long jiffies;
1129			};
1130			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1131			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1132			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1133			u32 flags;
1134			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1135		} control;
1136		struct {
1137			u64 cookie;
1138		} ack;
1139		struct {
1140			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1141			s32 ack_signal;
1142			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1143			u8 ampdu_len;
1144			u8 antenna;
 
1145			u16 tx_time;
1146			u8 flags;
1147			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
 
1148		} status;
1149		struct {
1150			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1151				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1152			u8 pad[4];
1153
1154			void *rate_driver_data[
1155				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1156		};
1157		void *driver_data[
1158			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1159	};
1160};
1161
1162static inline u16
1163ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1164{
1165	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1166	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1167	 */
1168	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1169	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1170}
1171
1172static inline u16
1173ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1174{
1175	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1176}
1177
1178/***
1179 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1180 *
1181 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1182 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1183 *
1184 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1185 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1186 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1187 * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1188 * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1189 */
1190struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1191	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1192	u8 try_count;
1193	u8 tx_power_idx;
1194};
1195
1196/**
1197 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1198 *
1199 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1200 * @info: Basic tx status information
1201 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1202 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1203 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1204 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1205 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1206 *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1207 *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1208 */
1209struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1210	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1211	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1212	struct sk_buff *skb;
1213	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1214	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1215	u8 n_rates;
1216
1217	struct list_head *free_list;
1218};
1219
1220/**
1221 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1222 *
1223 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1224 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1225 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1226 *
1227 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1228 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1229 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1230 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1231 */
1232struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1233	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1234	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1235	const u8 *common_ies;
1236	size_t common_ie_len;
1237};
1238
1239
1240static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1241{
1242	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1243}
1244
1245static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1246{
1247	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1248}
1249
1250/**
1251 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1252 *
1253 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1254 *
1255 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1256 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1257 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1258 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1259 *
1260 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1261 *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1262 *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1263 */
1264static inline void
1265ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1266{
1267	int i;
1268
1269	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1270		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1271	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1272		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1273	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1274	/* clear the rate counts */
1275	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1276		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1277	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1278}
1279
1280
1281/**
1282 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1283 *
1284 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1285 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1286 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1287 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1288 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1289 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1290 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1291 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1292 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1293 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1294 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1295 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1296 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1297 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1298 *	de-duplication by itself.
1299 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1300 *	the frame.
1301 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1302 *	the frame.
 
 
 
1303 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1304 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1305 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1306 *	merging.
1307 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1308 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1309 *	(including FCS) was received.
1310 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1311 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
 
 
 
 
 
1312 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1313 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1314 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1315 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1316 *	each A-MPDU
1317 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1318 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1319 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1320 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1321 *	on this subframe
1322 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1323 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1324 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1325 *	done by the hardware
1326 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1327 *	processing it in any regular way.
1328 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1329 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1330 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1331 *	monitor interfaces.
1332 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1333 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1334 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1335 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1336 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1337 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1338 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1339 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1340 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1341 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1342 *	interleaved with other frames.
1343 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1344 *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1345 *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
 
 
 
1346 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1347 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1348 *	the first subframe.
1349 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1350 *	be done in the hardware.
1351 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1352 *	frame
1353 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1354 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1355 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1356 *	
1357 *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1358 *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1359 *	 - DATA3_CODING
1360 *	 - DATA5_GI
1361 *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1362 *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1363 *	 - DATA3_STBC
1364 *	
1365 *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1366 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1367 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1368 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1369 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1370 *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1371 *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1372 *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1373 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1374 *	hardware or driver)
1375 */
1376enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1377	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1378	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1379	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1380	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1381	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1382	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1383	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1384	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1385	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1386	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1387	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1388	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1389	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1390	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1391	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1392	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1393	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1394	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
 
 
1395	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1396	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1397	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1398	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1399	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1400	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1401	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1402	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1403	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1404	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1405	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1406	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1407	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1408};
1409
1410/**
1411 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1412 *
1413 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1414 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1415 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1416 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1417 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1418 *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1419 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1420 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1421 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1422 */
1423enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1424	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1425	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1426	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1427	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1428	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1429	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1430};
1431
1432#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1433
1434enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1435	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1436	RX_ENC_HT,
1437	RX_ENC_VHT,
1438	RX_ENC_HE,
 
1439};
1440
1441/**
1442 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1443 *
1444 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1445 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1446 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1447 *
1448 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1449 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1450 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1451 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1452 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1453 *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1454 *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1455 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1456 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1457 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1458 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1459 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1460 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1461 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1462 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1463 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1464 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1465 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1466 *	values were filled.
1467 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1468 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1469 * @antenna: antenna used
1470 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1471 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1472 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1473 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1474 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1475 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1476 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1477 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1478 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1479 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
 
 
 
1480 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1481 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1482 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1483 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1484 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1485 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1486 *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1487 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1488 *	@link_valid.
1489 */
1490struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1491	u64 mactime;
1492	union {
1493		u64 boottime_ns;
1494		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1495	};
1496	u32 device_timestamp;
1497	u32 ampdu_reference;
1498	u32 flag;
1499	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1500	u8 enc_flags;
1501	u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1502	u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1503	u8 rate_idx;
1504	u8 nss;
1505	u8 rx_flags;
1506	u8 band;
1507	u8 antenna;
1508	s8 signal;
1509	u8 chains;
1510	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1511	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1512	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1513	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1514};
1515
1516static inline u32
1517ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1518{
1519	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1520	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1521}
1522
1523/**
1524 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1525 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1526 *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1527 *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1528 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1529 *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1530 *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1531 *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1532 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1533 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1534 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1535 *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1536 *	@data field.
1537 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1538 *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1539 *	length
1540 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1541 *
1542 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1543 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1544 * data.
1545 */
1546struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1547	u32 present;
1548	u8 align;
1549	u8 oui[3];
1550	u8 subns;
1551	u8 pad;
1552	u16 len;
1553	u8 data[];
1554} __packed;
1555
1556/**
1557 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1558 *
1559 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1560 *
1561 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1562 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1563 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1564 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1565 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1566 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1567 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1568 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1569 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1570 *	for more.
1571 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1572 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1573 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1574 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1575 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1576 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1577 *	operating channel.
1578 */
1579enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1580	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1581	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1582	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1583	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1584};
1585
1586
1587/**
1588 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1589 *
1590 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1591 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1592 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1593 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1594 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1595 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1596 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1597 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1598 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1599 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1600 */
1601enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1602	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1603	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1604	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1605	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1606	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1607	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1608	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1609	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1610};
1611
1612/**
1613 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1614 *
1615 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1616 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1617 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1618 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1619 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1620 */
1621enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1622	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1623	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1624	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1625	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1626
1627	/* keep last */
1628	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1629};
1630
1631/**
1632 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1633 *
1634 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1635 *
1636 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1637 *
1638 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1639 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1640 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1641 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1642 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1643 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1644 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1645 *
1646 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1647 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1648 *
1649 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1650 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1651 *
1652 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1653 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1654 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1655 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1656 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1657 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1658 *
1659 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1660 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1661 *	configured for an HT channel.
1662 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1663 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1664 */
1665struct ieee80211_conf {
1666	u32 flags;
1667	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1668
1669	u16 listen_interval;
1670	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1671
1672	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1673
1674	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1675	bool radar_enabled;
1676	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1677};
1678
1679/**
1680 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1681 *
1682 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1683 * operation.
1684 *
1685 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1686 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1687 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1688 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1689 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1690 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1691 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1692 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1693 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1694 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1695 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1696  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1697  *	channel, expressed in TU.
 
1698 */
1699struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1700	u64 timestamp;
1701	u32 device_timestamp;
1702	bool block_tx;
1703	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1704	u8 count;
 
1705	u32 delay;
1706};
1707
1708/**
1709 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1710 *
1711 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1712 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1713 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1714 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1715 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1716 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1717 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1718 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1719 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1720 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1721 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1722 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1723 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
 
 
 
 
 
 
1724 */
1725enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1726	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1727	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1728	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1729	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
 
 
1730};
1731
1732
1733/**
1734 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1735 *
1736 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1737 *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1738 *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1739 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1740 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1741 *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1742 *	mac80211.
1743 */
1744
1745enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1746	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1747	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1748	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1749};
1750
1751/**
1752 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1753 * @assoc: association status
1754 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1755 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1756 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1757 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1758 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 
 
 
 
 
1759 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1760 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1761 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1762 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1763 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1764 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1765 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1766 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1767 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1768 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1769 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1770 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1771 *	your driver/device needs to do.
1772 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1773 *	(station mode only)
1774 */
1775struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1776	/* association related data */
1777	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1778	bool ibss_creator;
1779	bool ps;
1780	u16 aid;
 
 
 
1781
1782	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1783	int arp_addr_cnt;
1784	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1785	size_t ssid_len;
1786	bool s1g;
1787	bool idle;
1788	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1789};
1790
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1791/**
1792 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1793 *
1794 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1795 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1796 *
1797 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1798 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1799 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1800 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1801 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1802 *	indexed by link ID
1803 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1804 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1805 *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1806 *	API calls meant for that purpose.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1807 * @addr: address of this interface
 
 
1808 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1809 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1810 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1811 *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1812 *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1813 *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1814 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1815 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1816 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1817 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1818 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1819 *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1820 *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1821 *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1822 *	restrictions.
1823 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1824 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1825 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1826 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1827 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1828 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1829 *	interface.
1830 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1831 *	for this interface.
1832 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1833 *	sizeof(void \*).
1834 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1835 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1836 *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1837 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1838 */
1839struct ieee80211_vif {
1840	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1841	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1842	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1843	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1844	u16 valid_links, active_links;
 
1845	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
 
1846	bool p2p;
1847
1848	u8 cab_queue;
1849	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1850
1851	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1852
1853	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1854	u32 driver_flags;
1855	u32 offload_flags;
1856
1857#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1858	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1859#endif
1860
1861	bool probe_req_reg;
1862	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1863
1864	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1865
1866	/* must be last */
1867	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1868};
1869
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1870#define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1871	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1872		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1873		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1874		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1875
1876static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1877{
1878#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1879	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1880#endif
1881	return false;
1882}
1883
1884/**
1885 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1886 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1887 *
1888 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1889 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1890 *
1891 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1892 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1893 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1894 */
1895struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1896
1897/**
1898 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1899 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1900 *
1901 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1902 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1903 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
 
 
1904 */
1905struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1906
1907/**
1908 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1909 * @vif: the interface to check
1910 */
1911static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1912{
1913	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1914}
1915
1916#define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1917	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1918				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1919
1920#define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1921	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1922			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1923
1924/**
1925 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1926 *
1927 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1928 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1929 *
1930 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1931 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1932 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1933 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1934 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1935 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1936 *	generation in software.
1937 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1938 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1939 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1940 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1941 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1942 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1943 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1944 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1945 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1946 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1947 *	MIC.
1948 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1949 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1950 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1951 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1952 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1953 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1954 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1955 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1956 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1957 *	only for management frames (MFP).
1958 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1959 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1960 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1961 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1962 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1963 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1964 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1965 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1966 *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1967 *	generation only
 
 
1968 */
1969enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1970	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1971	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1972	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1973	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1974	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1975	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1976	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1977	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1978	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
1979	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
1980	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
 
1981};
1982
1983/**
1984 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1985 *
1986 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1987 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1988 *
1989 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1990 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1991 *	encrypted in hardware.
1992 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1993 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1994 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1995 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1996 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1997 * @keylen: key material length
1998 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1999 * 	data block:
2000 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2001 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2002 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2003 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2004 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2005 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2006 */
2007struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2008	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2009	u32 cipher;
2010	u8 icv_len;
2011	u8 iv_len;
2012	u8 hw_key_idx;
2013	s8 keyidx;
2014	u16 flags;
2015	s8 link_id;
2016	u8 keylen;
2017	u8 key[];
2018};
2019
2020#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2021
2022#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2023#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2024
2025/**
2026 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2027 *
2028 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2029 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2030 *	reverse order than in packet)
2031 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2032 *	reverse order than in packet)
2033 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2034 *	reverse order than in packet)
2035 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2036 *	reverse order than in packet)
2037 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2038 */
2039struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2040	union {
2041		struct {
2042			u32 iv32;
2043			u16 iv16;
2044		} tkip;
2045		struct {
2046			u8 pn[6];
2047		} ccmp;
2048		struct {
2049			u8 pn[6];
2050		} aes_cmac;
2051		struct {
2052			u8 pn[6];
2053		} aes_gmac;
2054		struct {
2055			u8 pn[6];
2056		} gcmp;
2057		struct {
2058			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2059			u8 seq_len;
2060		} hw;
2061	};
2062};
2063
2064/**
2065 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2066 *
2067 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2068 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2069 *
2070 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2071 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2072 */
2073enum set_key_cmd {
2074	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2075};
2076
2077/**
2078 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2079 *
2080 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2081 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2082 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2083 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2084 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2085 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2086 */
2087enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2088	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2089	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2090	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2091	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2092	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2093	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2094};
2095
2096/**
2097 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2098 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2099 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2100 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2101 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2102 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2103 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2104 *
2105 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2106 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2107 */
2108enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2109	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2110	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2111	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2112	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2113	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2114};
2115
2116/**
2117 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2118 *
2119 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2120 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2121 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2122 */
2123struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2124	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2125	struct {
2126		s8 idx;
2127		u8 count;
2128		u8 count_cts;
2129		u8 count_rts;
2130		u16 flags;
2131	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2132};
2133
2134/**
2135 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2136 *
2137 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2138 *
2139 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2140 *	to the STA.
2141 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2142 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2143 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2144 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2145 *	per peer TPC.
2146 */
2147struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2148	s16 power;
2149	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2150};
2151
2152/**
2153 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2154 *
2155 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2156 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2157 *
2158 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2159 *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2160 *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2161 *
2162 *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2163 *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2164 *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2165 *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2166 *
2167 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2168 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2169 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2170 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2171 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2172 */
2173struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2174	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2175
2176	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2177	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2178};
2179
2180/**
2181 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2182 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2183 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2184 *
2185 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2186 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2187 *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2188 *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2189 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2190 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2191 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2192 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2193 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2194 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2195 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2196 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
 
2197 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2198 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2199 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2200 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2201 *	the station moves to associated state.
2202 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2203 *
2204 */
2205struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2206	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2207
2208	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2209	u8 link_id;
2210	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2211
2212	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2213	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2214	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2215	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2216	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2217	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2218
2219	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2220
2221	u8 rx_nss;
2222	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2223	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2224};
2225
2226/**
2227 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2228 *
2229 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2230 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2231 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2232 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2233 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2234 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2235 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2236 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2237 *
2238 * @addr: MAC address
2239 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2240 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2241 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2242 *	Can be modified by driver.
2243 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2244 *	otherwise always false)
2245 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2246 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2247 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2248 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2249 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2250 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2251 * @rates: rate control selection table
2252 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2253 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2254 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2255 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2256 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2257 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2258 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2259 *	unlimited.
2260 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2261 *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2262 *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2263 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2264 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2265 *	is used for non-data frames
2266 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2267 *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2268 *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2269 *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2270 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2271 *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2272 *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2273 *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2274 *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2275 *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2276 *	by the AP.
2277 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
 
2278 */
2279struct ieee80211_sta {
2280	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2281	u16 aid;
2282	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2283	bool wme;
2284	u8 uapsd_queues;
2285	u8 max_sp;
2286	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2287	bool tdls;
2288	bool tdls_initiator;
2289	bool mfp;
2290	bool mlo;
 
2291	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2292
2293	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2294
2295	bool support_p2p_ps;
2296
2297	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2298
2299	u16 valid_links;
2300	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2301	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2302
2303	/* must be last */
2304	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2305};
2306
2307#ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2308bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2309#else
2310static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2311{
2312	return true;
2313}
2314#endif
2315
2316#define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2317	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2318				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2319
2320#define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2321	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2322			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2323
2324#define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2325	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2326		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2327		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2328		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2329
2330/**
2331 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2332 *
2333 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2334 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2335 *
2336 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2337 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2338 */
2339enum sta_notify_cmd {
2340	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2341};
2342
2343/**
2344 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2345 *
2346 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2347 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2348 */
2349struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2350	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2351};
2352
2353/**
2354 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2355 *
2356 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2357 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2358 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2359 *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2360 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2361 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2362 *
2363 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2364 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2365 */
2366struct ieee80211_txq {
2367	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2368	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2369	u8 tid;
2370	u8 ac;
2371
2372	/* must be last */
2373	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2374};
2375
2376/**
2377 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2378 *
2379 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2380 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2381 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2382 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2383 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2384 *
2385 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2386 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2387 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2388 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2389 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2390 *	algorithm.
2391 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2392 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2393 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2394 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2395 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2396 *	CCK frames.
2397 *
2398 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2399 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2400 *	the FCS at the end.
2401 *
2402 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2403 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2404 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2405 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2406 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2407 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2408 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2409 *
2410 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2411 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2412 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2413 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2414 *
2415 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2416 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2417 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2418 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2419 *
2420 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2421 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2422 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2423 *
2424 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2425 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2426 *
2427 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2428 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2429 *
2430 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2431 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2432 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2433 *
2434 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2435 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2436 *
2437 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2438 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2439 *
2440 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2441 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2442 *	the stack.
2443 *
2444 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2445 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2446 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2447 *
2448 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2449 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2450 *	dtim_period).
2451 *
2452 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2453 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2454 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2455 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2456 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2457 *	only in that case.
2458 *
2459 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2460 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2461 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2462 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2463 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2464 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2465 *
2466 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2467 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2468 *	software.
2469 *
2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2471 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2472 *	active interfaces.
2473 *
 
 
 
 
 
2474 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2475 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2476 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2477 *
2478 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2479 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2480 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2481 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2482 *	supported cipher suites.
2483 *
2484 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2485 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2486 *	for frames.
2487 *
2488 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2489 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2490 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2491 *	control for more details.
2492 *
2493 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2494 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2495 *
2496 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2497 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2498 *	is supported.
2499 *
2500 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2501 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2502 *
2503 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2504 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2505 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2506 *
2507 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2508 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2509 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2510 *	CSA frame.
2511 *
2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2513 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2514 *
2515 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2516 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2517 *
2518 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2519 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2520 *
2521 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2522 *	within A-MPDU.
2523 *
2524 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2525 *	for sent beacons.
2526 *
2527 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2528 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2529 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2530 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2531 *
2532 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2533 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2534 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2535 *	timeout.
2536 *
2537 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2538 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2539 *
2540 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2541 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2542 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2543 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2544 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2545 *
2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2547 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2548 *
2549 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2550 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2551 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2552 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2553 *
2554 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2555 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2556 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2557 *
2558 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2559 *	TDLS links.
2560 *
2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2562 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2563 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2564 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2565 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2566 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2567 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2568 *
2569 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2570 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2571 *
2572 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2573 *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2574 *
2575 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2576 *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2577 *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2578 *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2579 *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2580 *
2581 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2582 *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2583 *	TXQs to start with.
2584 *
2585 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2586 *	length in tx status information
2587 *
2588 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2589 *
2590 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2591 *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2592 *
2593 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2594 *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2595 *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2596 *
2597 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2598 *	offload
2599 *
2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2601 *	offload
2602 *
2603 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2604 *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2605 *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2606 *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2607 *	the stack.
2608 *
2609 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2610 *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2611 *
2612 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2613 *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2614 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2615 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2616 */
2617enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2618	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2619	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2620	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2621	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2622	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2623	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2624	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2625	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2626	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2627	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2628	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2629	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2630	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
 
2631	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2632	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2633	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2634	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2635	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2636	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2637	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2638	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2639	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2640	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2641	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2642	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2643	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2644	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2645	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2646	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2647	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2648	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2649	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2650	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2651	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2652	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2653	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2654	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2655	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2656	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2657	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2658	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2659	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2660	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2661	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2662	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2663	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2664	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2665	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2666	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2667	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2668	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2669	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2670	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2671	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
 
 
 
2672
2673	/* keep last, obviously */
2674	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2675};
2676
2677/**
2678 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2679 *
2680 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2681 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2682 *
2683 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2684 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2685 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2686 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2687 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2688 *
2689 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2690 *
2691 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2692 *	along with this structure.
2693 *
2694 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2695 *
2696 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2697 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2698 *
2699 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2700 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2701 *
2702 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2703 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2704 *
2705 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2706 *	that HW supports
2707 *
2708 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2709 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2710 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2711 *
2712 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2713 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2714 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2715 *
2716 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2717 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2718 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2719 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2720 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2721 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2722 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2723 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2724 *
2725 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2726 *	can handle.
2727 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2728 *	the hw can report back.
2729 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2730 *
2731 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2732 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2733 *	aggregation.
2734 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2735 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2736 *	it shouldn't be set.
2737 *
2738 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2739 *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2740 *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2741 *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2742 *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2743 *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2744 *
2745 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2746 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2747 *
2748 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2749 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2750 *
2751 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2752 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2753 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2754 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2755 *
2756 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2757 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2758 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2759 *
2760 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2761 *
2762 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2763 *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2764 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2765 *	device_timestamp.
2766 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2767 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2768 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2769 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2770 *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2771 *
2772 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2773 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2774 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2775 *
2776 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2777 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2778 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2779 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2780 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2781 *	neither enabled.
2782 *
2783 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2784 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2785 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2786 *
2787 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2788 *	device.
2789 *
2790 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2791 *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2792 *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2793 *
2794 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2795 *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2796 *
2797 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2798 *
2799 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2800 * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2801 * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2802 *
2803 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2804 */
2805struct ieee80211_hw {
2806	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2807	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2808	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2809	void *priv;
2810	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2811	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2812	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2813	int vif_data_size;
2814	int sta_data_size;
2815	int chanctx_data_size;
2816	int txq_data_size;
2817	u16 queues;
2818	u16 max_listen_interval;
2819	s8 max_signal;
2820	u8 max_rates;
2821	u8 max_report_rates;
2822	u8 max_rate_tries;
2823	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2824	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2825	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2826	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2827	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2828	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2829	struct {
2830		int units_pos;
2831		s16 accuracy;
2832	} radiotap_timestamp;
2833	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2834	u8 uapsd_queues;
2835	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2836	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2837	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2838	u8 weight_multiplier;
2839	u32 max_mtu;
2840	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2841	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2842};
2843
2844static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2845				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2846{
2847	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2848}
2849#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2850
2851static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2852				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2853{
2854	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2855}
2856#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2857
2858/**
2859 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2860 *
2861 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2862 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2863 */
2864struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2865	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2866
2867	/* Keep last */
2868	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2869};
2870
2871/**
2872 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2873 *
2874 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2875 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2876 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2877 * @status: channel-switch response status
2878 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2879 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2880 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2881 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2882 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2883 */
2884struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2885	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2886	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2887	u8 action_code;
2888	u32 status;
2889	u32 timestamp;
2890	u16 switch_time;
2891	u16 switch_timeout;
2892	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2893	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2894};
2895
2896/**
2897 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2898 *
2899 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2900 *
2901 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2902 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2903 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2904 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2905 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2906 *
2907 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2908 */
2909struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2910
2911/**
2912 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2913 *
2914 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2915 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2916 */
2917static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2918{
2919	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2920}
2921
2922/**
2923 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2924 *
2925 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2926 * @addr: the address to set
2927 */
2928static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2929{
2930	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2931}
2932
2933static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2934ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2935		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2936{
2937	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2938		return NULL;
2939	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2940}
2941
2942static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2943ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2944			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2945{
2946	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2947		return NULL;
2948	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2949}
2950
2951static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2952ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2953			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2954{
2955	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2956		return NULL;
2957	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2958}
2959
2960/**
2961 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2962 * @hw: the hardware
2963 * @skb: the skb
2964 *
2965 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
2966 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2967 */
2968void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2969
2970/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2971 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2972 *
2973 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2974 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2975 *
2976 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2977 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2978 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2979 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2980 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2981 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2982 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2983 *
2984 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2985 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2986 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2987 *
2988 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2989 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2990 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2991 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2992 *
2993 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2994 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2995 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2996 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2997 *
2998 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2999 *
3000 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3001 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3002 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3003 * based on the receive flags.
3004 *
3005 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3006 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3007 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3008 * keys.
3009 *
3010 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3011 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3012 * handler.
3013 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3014 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3015 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3016 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3017 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3018 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3019 *
3020 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3021 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3022 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3023 *
3024 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3025 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3026 * requirements:
3027 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3028      once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3029   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3030      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3031   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3032      encrypted with the new key when also needing
3033      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3034   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3035   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3036 */
3037
3038/**
3039 * DOC: Powersave support
3040 *
3041 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3042 *
3043 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3044 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3045 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3046 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3047 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3048 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3049 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3050 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3051 *
3052 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3053 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3054 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3055 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3056 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3057 *
3058 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3059 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3060 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3061 *
3062 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3063 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3064 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3065 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3066 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3067 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3068 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3069 *
3070 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3071 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3072 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3073 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3074 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3075 * periods.
3076 *
3077 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3078 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3079 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3080 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3081 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3082 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3083 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3084 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3085 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3086 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3087 *
3088 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3089 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3090 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3091 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3092 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3093 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3094 *
3095 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3096 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3097 */
3098
3099/**
3100 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3101 *
3102 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3103 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3104 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3105 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3106 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3107 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3108 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3109 *
3110 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3111 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3112 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3113 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3114 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3115 *
3116 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3117 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3118 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3119 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3120 *
3121 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3122 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3123 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3124 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3125 *
3126 *  - a list of information element IDs
3127 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3128 *
3129 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3130 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3131 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3132 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3133 * vendor information elements.
3134 *
3135 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3136 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3137 *
3138 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3139 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3140 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3141 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3142 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3143 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3144 *
3145 *
3146 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3147 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3148 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3149 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3150 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3151 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3152 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3153 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3154 *
3155 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3156 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3157 * signal strength threshold checking.
3158 */
3159
3160/**
3161 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3162 *
3163 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3164 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3165 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3166 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3167 *
3168 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3169 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3170 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3171 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3172 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3173 * hardware flags.
3174 *
3175 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3176 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3177 * turned off otherwise.
3178 *
3179 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3180 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3181 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3182 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3183 */
3184
3185/**
3186 * DOC: Frame filtering
3187 *
3188 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3189 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3190 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3191 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3192 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3193 *
3194 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3195 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3196 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3197 *
3198 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3199 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3200 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3201 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3202 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3203 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3204 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3205 *
3206 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3207 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3208 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3209 * or dropped.
3210 *
3211 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3212 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3213 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3214 * the flag, but not clear it.
3215 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3216 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3217 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3218 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3219 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3220 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3221 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3222 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3223 */
3224
3225/**
3226 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3227 *
3228 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3229 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3230 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3231 *
3232 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3233 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3234 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3235 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3236 * the driver code.
3237 *
3238 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3239 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3240 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3241 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3242 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3243 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3244 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3245 *
3246 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3247 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3248 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3249 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3250 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3251 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3252 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3253 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3254 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3255 * @sta_notify callback.
3256 *
3257 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3258 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3259 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3260 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3261 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3262 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3263 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3264 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3265 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3266 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3267 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3268 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3269 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3270 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3271 *
3272 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3273 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3274 *
3275 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3276 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3277 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3278 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3279 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3280 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3281 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3282 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3283 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3284 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3285 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3286 *
3287 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3288 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3289 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3290 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3291 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3292 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3293 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3294 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3295 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3296 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3297 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3298 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3299 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3300 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3301 *
3302 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3303 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3304 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3305 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3306 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3307 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3308 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3309 *
3310 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3311 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3312 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3313 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3314 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3315 *
3316 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3317 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3318 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3319 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3320 */
3321
3322/**
3323 * DOC: HW queue control
3324 *
3325 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3326 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3327 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3328 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3329 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3330 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3331 *
3332 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3333 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3334 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3335 *
3336 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3337 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3338 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3339 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3340 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3341 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3342 * the hardware queue.
3343 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3344 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3345 *
3346 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3347 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3348 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3349 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3350 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3351 *
3352 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3353 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3354 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3355 * off-channel queue:         9
3356 *
3357 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3358 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3359 *
3360 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3361 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3362 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3363 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3364 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3365 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3366 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3367 *
3368 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3369 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3370 *
3371 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3372 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3373 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3374 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3375 */
3376
3377/**
3378 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3379 *
3380 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3381 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3382 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3383 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3384 *
3385 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3386 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3387 *	multicast address.
3388 *
3389 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3390 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3391 *
3392 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3393 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3394 *
3395 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3396 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3397 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3398 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3399 *	honour this flag if possible.
3400 *
3401 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3402 *	station
3403 *
3404 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3405 *
3406 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3407 *
3408 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3409 *
3410 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3411 */
3412enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3413	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3414	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3415	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3416	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3417	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3418	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3419	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3420	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3421	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3422};
3423
3424/**
3425 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3426 *
3427 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3428 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3429 *
3430 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3431 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3432 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3433 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3434 *
3435 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3436 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3437 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3438 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3439 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3440 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3441 *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3442 *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3443 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3444 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3445 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3446 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3447 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3448 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3449 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3450 *	session is gone and removes the station.
3451 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3452 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3453 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3454 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3455 */
3456enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3457	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3458	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3459	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3460	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3461	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3462	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3463	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3464};
3465
3466#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3467#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3468
3469/**
3470 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3471 *
3472 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3473 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3474 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3475 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3476 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3477 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3478 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3479 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3480 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3481 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3482 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3483 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3484 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3485 */
3486struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3487	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3488	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3489	u16 tid;
3490	u16 ssn;
3491	u16 buf_size;
3492	bool amsdu;
3493	u16 timeout;
3494};
3495
3496/**
3497 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3498 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3499 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3500 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3501 */
3502enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3503	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3504	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3505};
3506
3507/**
3508 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3509 *
3510 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3511 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3512 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3513 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3514 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3515 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3516 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3517 *	the peer.
3518 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3519 *	by the peer
3520 */
3521enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3522	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3523	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3524	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3525	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3526};
3527
3528/**
3529 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3530 *
3531 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3532 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3533 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3534 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3535 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3536 *
3537 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3538 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3539 *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3540 */
3541enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3542	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3543	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3544};
3545
3546/**
3547 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3548 *
3549 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3550 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3551 *
3552 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3553 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3554 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3555 *	of wowlan configuration)
3556 */
3557enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3558	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3559	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3560};
3561
3562/**
3563 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3564 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3565 *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3566 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3567 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3568 *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3569 *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
 
 
 
 
3570 */
3571struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3572	u16 duration;
3573	u16 subtype;
3574	u8 success:1;
 
3575};
3576
3577/**
3578 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3579 *
3580 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3581 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3582 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3583 *
3584 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3585 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3586 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3587 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3588 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3589 *	Must be atomic.
3590 *
3591 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3592 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3593 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3594 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3595 *	or zero.
3596 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3597 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3598 *	is added.
3599 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3600 *
3601 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3602 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3603 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3604 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3605 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3606 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3607 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3608 *
3609 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3610 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3611 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3612 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3613 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3614 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3615 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3616 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3617 *	must return 1 from this function.
3618 *
3619 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3620 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3621 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3622 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3623 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3624 *
3625 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3626 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3627 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3628 *	in suspend().
3629 *
3630 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3631 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3632 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3633 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3634 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3635 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3636 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3637 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3638 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3639 *
3640 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3641 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3642 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3643 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3644 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3645 *
3646 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3647 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3648 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3649 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3650 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3651 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3652 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3653 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3654 *
3655 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3656 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3657 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3658 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3659 *
3660 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3661 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3662 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3663 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3664 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3665 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3666 *	can sleep.
3667 *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3668 *	are not implemented.
3669 *
3670 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3671 *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3672 *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3673 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3674 *	The callback can sleep.
3675 *
3676 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3677 *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3678 *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3679 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3680 *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3681 *	non-MLO connections.
3682 *	The callback can sleep.
3683 *
3684 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3685 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3686 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3687 *
3688 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3689 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3690 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3691 *
3692 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3693 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3694 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3695 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3696 *	which flags are changed.
3697 *	This callback can sleep.
3698 *
3699 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3700 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3701 *
3702 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3703 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3704 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3705 *	is enabled.
3706 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3707 *	The callback can sleep.
3708 *
3709 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3710 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3711 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3712 *	The callback must be atomic.
3713 *
3714 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3715 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3716 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3717 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3718 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3719 *
3720 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3721 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3722 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3723 *
3724 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3725 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3726 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3727 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3728 *	that power save is disabled.
3729 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3730 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3731 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3732 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3733 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3734 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3735 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3736 *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3737 *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3738 *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3739 *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3740 *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3741 *	The callback can sleep.
3742 *
3743 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3744 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3745 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3746 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3747 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3748 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3749 *	The callback can sleep.
3750 *
3751 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3752 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3753 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3754 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3755 *
3756 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3757 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3758 *
3759 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3760 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3761 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3762 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3763 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3764 *
3765 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3766 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3767 *	this notification.
3768 *	The callback can sleep.
3769 *
3770 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3771 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3772 *	The callback can sleep.
3773 *
3774 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3775 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3776 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3777 *	The callback must be atomic.
3778 *
3779 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3780 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3781 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3782 *	should be set as well.
3783 *	The callback can sleep.
3784 *
3785 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3786 *	The callback can sleep.
3787 *
3788 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3789 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3790 *
3791 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3792 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3793 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3794 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3795 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3796 *	This callback can sleep.
3797 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3798 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3799 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3800 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3801 *	callback can sleep.
3802 *
3803 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3804 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3805 *	should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3806 *	callback can sleep.
3807 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3808 *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3809 *
3810 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3811 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3812 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3813 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3814 *
3815 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3816 *	power for the station.
3817 *	This callback can sleep.
3818 *
3819 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3820 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3821 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3822 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3823 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3824 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3825 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3826 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3827 *	The callback can sleep.
3828 *
3829 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3830 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3831 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3832 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3833 *	in @sta_state.
3834 *	The callback can sleep.
3835 *
3836 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3837 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3838 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3839 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3840 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3841 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3842 *	Must be atomic.
3843 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3844 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3845 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3846 *
3847 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3848 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3849 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3850 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3851 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3852 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3853 *	The callback can sleep.
3854 *
3855 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3856 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3857 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3858 *	The callback can sleep.
3859 *
3860 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3861 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3862 *	required function.
3863 *	The callback can sleep.
3864 *
3865 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3866 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3867 *	required function.
3868 *	The callback can sleep.
3869 *
3870 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3871 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3872 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3873 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3874 *	The callback can sleep.
3875 *
3876 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3877 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3878 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3879 *	TSF synchronization.
3880 *	The callback can sleep.
3881 *
3882 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3883 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3884 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3885 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3886 *	The callback can sleep.
3887 *
3888 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3889 *
3890 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3891 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3892 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3893 *	The callback can sleep.
3894 *
3895 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3896 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3897 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3898 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3899 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3900 *
3901 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3902 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3903 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3904 *
3905 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3906 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3907 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3908 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3909 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3910 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3911 *	The callback can sleep.
3912 *
 
 
 
 
3913 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3914 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3915 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3916 *	completion of the channel switch.
3917 *
3918 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3919 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3920 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3921 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3922 *
3923 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3924 *
3925 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3926 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3927 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3928 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3929 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3930 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3931 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3932 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3933 *	must be accepted in this case.
3934 *	This callback may sleep.
3935 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3936 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3937 *
3938 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3939 *
3940 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3941 *
3942 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3943 *	queues before entering power save.
3944 *
3945 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3946 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3947 *	The callback can sleep.
3948 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3949 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3950 *	The callback must be atomic.
3951 *
3952 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3953 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3954 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3955 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3956 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3957 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3958 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3959 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3960 *	more-data bit must always be set.
3961 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3962 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3963 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3964 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3965 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3966 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3967 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3968 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3969 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3970 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3971 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3972 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3973 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3974 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3975 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3976 *	This callback must be atomic.
3977 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3978 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3979 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3980 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3981 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3982 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3983 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3984 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3985 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3986 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3987 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3988 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3989 *	This callback must be atomic.
3990 *
3991 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
 
 
3992 *
3993 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3994 *
3995 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3996 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
 
 
3997 *
3998 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3999 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4000 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4001 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4002 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4003 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4004 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4005 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4006 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4007 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4008 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4009 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4010 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4011 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4012 *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4013 *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4014 *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4015 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4016 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4017 *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4018 *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4019 *
4020 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4021 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4022 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4023 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4024 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4025 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4026 *	2 * (DTIM period).
4027 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4028 *
4029 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4030 *	This callback may sleep.
4031 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4032 *	This callback may sleep.
4033 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4034 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4035 *	channel context with different settings
4036 *	This callback may sleep.
4037 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4038 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4039 *	This callback may sleep.
4040 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4041 *	unbound from vif.
4042 *	This callback may sleep.
4043 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4044 *	another, as specified in the list of
4045 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4046 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4047 *	This callback may sleep.
4048 *
4049 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4050 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4051 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4052 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4053 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4054 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4055 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4056 *
4057 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4058 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4059 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4060 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4061 *	This callback may sleep.
4062 *
4063 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4064 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4065 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4066 *
4067 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4068 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4069 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4070 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4071 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4072 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4073 *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4074 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4075 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4076 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4077 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4078 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4079 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4080 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4081 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4082 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4083 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4084 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4085 *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4086 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4087 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4088 *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4089 *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4090 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4091 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4092 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4093 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4094 *
4095 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4096 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4097 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4098 *
4099 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4100 *	and hardware limits.
4101 *
4102 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4103 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4104 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4105 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4106 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4107 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4108 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4109 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4110 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4111 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4112 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4113 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4114 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4115 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4116 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4117 *	the function call.
4118 *
4119 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4120 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4121 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4122 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4123 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4124 *
4125 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4126 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4127 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4128 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4129 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4130 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4131 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4132 *	changed parameters.
4133 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4134 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4135 *	this call.
4136 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4137 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4138 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4139 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4140 *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4141 *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4142 *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4143 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4144 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4145 *
4146 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4147 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4148 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4149 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4150 *	This callback may sleep.
4151 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4152 *	This callback may sleep.
4153 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4154 *	4-address mode
4155 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4156 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4157 *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4158 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4159 *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4160 *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4161 *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4162 *	twt structure.
4163 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4164 *	from the peer.
4165 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4166 *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4167 *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4168 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4169 *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4170 *	radar channel.
4171 *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4172 *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4173 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4174 *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
 
 
4175 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4176 *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4177 *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4178 *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4179 *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4180 *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4181 *	This callback can sleep.
4182 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4183 *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4184 *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4185 *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4186 *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4187 */
4188struct ieee80211_ops {
4189	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4190		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4191		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4192	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4193	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4194#ifdef CONFIG_PM
4195	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4196	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4197	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4198#endif
4199	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4200			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4201	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4202				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4203				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4204	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4205				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4206	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4207	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4208				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4209				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4210				 u64 changed);
4211	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4212				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4213				u64 changed);
4214	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4215				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4216				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4217				  u64 changed);
4218
4219	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4220			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4221	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4222			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4223
4224	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4225				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4226	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4227				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4228				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4229				 u64 multicast);
4230	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4231				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4232				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4233				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4234	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4235		       bool set);
4236	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4237		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4238		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4239	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4240				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4241				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4242				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4243				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4244	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4245			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4246			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4247	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4248					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4249	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4250		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4251	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4252			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4253	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4254				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4255				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4256				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4257	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4258			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4259	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4260			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4261			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4262	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4263				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4264	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4265			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4266	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4267			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4268			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4269	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4270	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4271	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4272		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4273	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4274			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4275#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
 
 
 
 
 
 
4276	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4277				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4278				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4279				struct dentry *dir);
4280	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4281				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4282				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4283				     struct dentry *dir);
4284#endif
4285	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4286			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4287	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4288			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4289			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4290	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4291			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4292			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4293			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4294	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4295				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4296				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4297	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4298			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4299			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4300			      u32 changed);
4301	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4302				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4303				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4304	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4305			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4306			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4307			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4308	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4309		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4310		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4311		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4312	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4313	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4314			u64 tsf);
4315	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4316			   s64 offset);
4317	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4318	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4319
4320	/**
4321	 * @ampdu_action:
4322	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4323	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4324	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4325	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4326	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4327	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4328	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4329	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4330	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4331	 *
4332	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4333	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4334	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4335	 *
4336	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4337	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4338	 *
4339	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4340	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4341	 * - ``TX:        81``
4342	 *
4343	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4344	 *
4345	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4346	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4347	 * if the session can start immediately.
4348	 *
4349	 * The callback can sleep.
4350	 */
4351	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4352			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4353			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4354	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4355		struct survey_info *survey);
4356	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4357	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4358#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4359	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4360			    void *data, int len);
4361	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4362			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4363			     void *data, int len);
4364#endif
4365	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4366		      u32 queues, bool drop);
 
 
4367	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4368			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4369			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4370	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4371	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4372
4373	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4374				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4375				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4376				 int duration,
4377				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4378	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4379					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4380	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4381	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4382			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4383	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4384	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4385				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4386	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4387			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4388			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4389
4390	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4391				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4392				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4393				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4394				      bool more_data);
4395	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4396					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4397					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4398					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4399					bool more_data);
4400
4401	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4402				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4403	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4404				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4405				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4406	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4407				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4408				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4409
4410	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4411				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4412				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4413	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4414				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4415				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4416
4417	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4418					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
4419
4420	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4421			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4422	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4423			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4424	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4425			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4426			       u32 changed);
4427	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4428				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4429				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4430				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4431	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4432				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4433				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4434				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4435	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4436				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4437				  int n_vifs,
4438				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4439
4440	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4441				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4442
4443#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4444	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4445				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4446				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4447#endif
4448	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4449				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4450				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4451	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4452				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4453				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4454
4455	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4456				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
4457	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4458				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
4459	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4461					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4462
4463	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4464	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4465	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4466				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4467	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4468			   int *dbm);
4469
4470	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4471				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4472				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4473				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4474				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4475	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4476					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4477					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4478	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4479					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4480					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4481
4482	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4483			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4484	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4485
4486	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4488			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4489	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4490			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4491	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4494	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4497	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499			    u8 instance_id);
4500	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4501				       struct sk_buff *head,
4502				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4503	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4505				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4506	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4507			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4508	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4509			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4510	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4512			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4513			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4514	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4515				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4516				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4517	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4518				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4519	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4521	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4523	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4525				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4526	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4528			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4529	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4530				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4531	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4533	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4534				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4535				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4536				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4537				     struct net_device_path *path);
 
 
 
4538	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4539				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4540				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4541				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4542	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4545				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4546};
4547
4548/**
4549 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4550 *
4551 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4552 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4553 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4554 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4555 * @priv_data_len.
4556 *
4557 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4558 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4559 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4560 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4561 *
4562 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4563 */
4564struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4565					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4566					   const char *requested_name);
4567
4568/**
4569 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4570 *
4571 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4572 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4573 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4574 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4575 * @priv_data_len.
4576 *
4577 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4578 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4579 *
4580 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4581 */
4582static inline
4583struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4584					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4585{
4586	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4587}
4588
4589/**
4590 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4591 *
4592 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4593 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4594 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4595 *
4596 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4597 *
4598 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4599 */
4600int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4601
4602/**
4603 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4604 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4605 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4606 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4607 */
4608struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4609	int throughput;
4610	int blink_time;
4611};
4612
4613/**
4614 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4615 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4616 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4617 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4618 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4619 */
4620enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4621	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4622	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4623	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4624};
4625
4626#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4627const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4628const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4629const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4630const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4631const char *
4632__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4633				   unsigned int flags,
4634				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4635				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4636#endif
4637/**
4638 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4639 *
4640 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4641 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4642 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4643 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4644 *
4645 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4646 *
4647 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4648 */
4649static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4650{
4651#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4652	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4653#else
4654	return NULL;
4655#endif
4656}
4657
4658/**
4659 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4660 *
4661 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4662 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4663 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4664 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4665 *
4666 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4667 *
4668 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4669 */
4670static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4671{
4672#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4673	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4674#else
4675	return NULL;
4676#endif
4677}
4678
4679/**
4680 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4681 *
4682 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4683 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4684 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4685 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4686 *
4687 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4688 *
4689 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4690 */
4691static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4692{
4693#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4694	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4695#else
4696	return NULL;
4697#endif
4698}
4699
4700/**
4701 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4702 *
4703 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4704 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4705 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4706 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4707 *
4708 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4709 *
4710 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4711 */
4712static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4713{
4714#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4715	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4716#else
4717	return NULL;
4718#endif
4719}
4720
4721/**
4722 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4723 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4724 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4725 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4726 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4727 *
4728 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4729 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4730 *
4731 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4732 */
4733static inline const char *
4734ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4735				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4736				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4737{
4738#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4739	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4740						  blink_table_len);
4741#else
4742	return NULL;
4743#endif
4744}
4745
4746/**
4747 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4748 *
4749 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4750 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4751 *
4752 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4753 */
4754void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4755
4756/**
4757 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4758 *
4759 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4760 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4761 * before calling this function.
4762 *
4763 * @hw: the hardware to free
4764 */
4765void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4766
4767/**
4768 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4769 *
4770 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4771 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4772 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4773 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4774 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4775 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4776 *
4777 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4778 */
4779void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4780
4781/**
4782 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4783 *
4784 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4785 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4786 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4787 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4788 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4789 *
4790 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4791 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4792 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4793 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4794 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4795 *
4796 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4797 *
4798 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4799 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4800 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4801 * @list: the destination list
4802 */
4803void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4804		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4805
4806/**
4807 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4808 *
4809 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4810 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4811 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4812 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4813 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4814 *
4815 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4816 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4817 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4818 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4819 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4820 *
4821 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4822 *
4823 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4824 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4825 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4826 * @napi: the NAPI context
4827 */
4828void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4829		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4830
4831/**
4832 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4833 *
4834 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4835 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4836 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4837 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4838 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4839 *
4840 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4841 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4842 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4843 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4844 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4845 *
4846 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4847 *
4848 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4849 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4850 */
4851static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4852{
4853	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4854}
4855
4856/**
4857 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4858 *
4859 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4860 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4861 *
4862 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4863 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4864 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4865 *
4866 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4867 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4868 */
4869void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4870
4871/**
4872 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4873 *
4874 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4875 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4876 *
4877 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4878 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4879 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4880 *
4881 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4882 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4883 */
4884static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4885				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4886{
4887	local_bh_disable();
4888	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4889	local_bh_enable();
4890}
4891
4892/**
4893 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4894 *
4895 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4896 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4897 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4898 *
4899 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4900 *
4901 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4902 * each other.
4903 *
4904 * @sta: currently connected sta
4905 * @start: start or stop PS
4906 *
4907 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4908 */
4909int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4910
4911/**
4912 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4913 *                                  (in process context)
4914 *
4915 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4916 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4917 * applies.
4918 *
4919 * @sta: currently connected sta
4920 * @start: start or stop PS
4921 *
4922 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4923 */
4924static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4925						  bool start)
4926{
4927	int ret;
4928
4929	local_bh_disable();
4930	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4931	local_bh_enable();
4932
4933	return ret;
4934}
4935
4936/**
4937 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4938 * @sta: currently connected station
4939 *
4940 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4941 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4942 * connected station was received.
4943 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4944 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4945 * be serialized.
4946 */
4947void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4948
4949/**
4950 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4951 * @sta: currently connected station
4952 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4953 *
4954 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4955 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4956 * from a connected station was received.
4957 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4958 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4959 * serialized.
4960 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4961 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4962 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4963 * checks.
4964 */
4965void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4966
4967/*
4968 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4969 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4970 */
4971#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4972
4973/**
4974 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4975 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4976 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4977 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4978 *
4979 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4980 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4981 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4982 *
4983 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4984 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4985 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4986 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4987 *
4988 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4989 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4990 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4991 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4992 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4993 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4994 *
4995 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4996 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4997 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4998 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4999 * use this API.
5000 */
5001void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5002				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5003
5004/**
5005 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5006 *
5007 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5008 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5009 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5010 *
5011 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5012 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5013 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5014 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5015 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5016 */
5017void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5018			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5019			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5020			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5021			    int max_rates);
5022
5023/**
5024 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5025 *
5026 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5027 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5028 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5029 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5030 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5031 * slow stations to starve).
5032 *
5033 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5034 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5035 */
5036void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5037					   u32 thr);
5038
5039/**
5040 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5041 *
5042 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5043 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5044 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5045 *
5046 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5047 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5048 * @info: tx status information
5049 */
5050void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5051			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5052			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5053
5054/**
5055 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5056 *
5057 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5058 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5059 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5060 *
5061 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5062 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5063 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5064 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5065 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5066 *
5067 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5068 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5069 */
5070void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5071			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5072
5073/**
5074 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5075 *
5076 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5077 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5078 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5079 *
5080 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5081 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5082 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5083 *
5084 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5085 * @status: tx status information
5086 */
5087void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5088			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5089
5090/**
5091 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5092 *
5093 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5094 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5095 * specific skbs.
5096 *
5097 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5098 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5099 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5100 *
5101 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5102 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5103 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5104 * @info: tx status information
5105 */
5106static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5107					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5108					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5109{
5110	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5111		.sta = sta,
5112		.info = info,
5113	};
5114
5115	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5116}
5117
5118/**
5119 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5120 *
5121 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5122 *
5123 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5124 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5125 * for a single hardware.
5126 *
5127 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5128 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5129 */
5130static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5131					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5132{
5133	local_bh_disable();
5134	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5135	local_bh_enable();
5136}
5137
5138/**
5139 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5140 *
5141 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5142 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5143 *
5144 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5145 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5146 *
5147 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5148 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5149 */
5150void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5151				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5152
5153/**
5154 * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
5155 *
5156 * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
5157 * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
5158 * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
5159 * 802.11 frames.
5160 *
5161 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5162 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
5163 * calls in the same tx status family.
5164 *
5165 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5166 * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
5167 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5168 */
5169void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5170			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5171			       struct sk_buff *skb);
5172
5173/**
5174 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5175 *
5176 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5177 * connected STA.
5178 *
5179 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5180 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5181 */
5182void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5183
5184#define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5185
5186/**
5187 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5188 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5189 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5190 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5191 *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5192 *	should be ignored.
5193 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5194 */
5195struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5196	u16 tim_offset;
5197	u16 tim_length;
5198
5199	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5200	u16 mbssid_off;
5201};
5202
5203/**
5204 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5205 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5206 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5207 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5208 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5209 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 
5210 *
5211 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5212 * obtain the beacon template.
5213 *
5214 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5215 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5216 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5217 * applicable, the CSA count.
5218 *
5219 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5220 *
5221 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5222 */
5223struct sk_buff *
5224ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5225			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5226			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5227			      unsigned int link_id);
5228
5229/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5230 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5231 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5232 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5233 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5234 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5235 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5236 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5237 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5238 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 
5239 *
5240 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5241 * obtain the beacon frame.
5242 *
5243 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5244 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5245 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5246 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5247 *
5248 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5249 *
5250 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5251 */
5252struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5253					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5254					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5255					 unsigned int link_id);
5256
5257/**
5258 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5259 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5260 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5261 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 
5262 *
5263 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5264 *
5265 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5266 */
5267static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5268						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5269						   unsigned int link_id)
5270{
5271	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5272}
5273
5274/**
5275 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5276 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5277 *
5278 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5279 * This function is called implicitly when
5280 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5281 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5282 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5283 *
5284 * Return: new countdown value
5285 */
5286u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
5287
5288/**
5289 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5290 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5291 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5292 *
5293 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5294 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5295 *
5296 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5297 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5298 */
5299void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5300
5301/**
5302 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5303 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5304 *
5305 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5306 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5307 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5308 */
5309void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5310
5311/**
5312 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5313 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5314 *
5315 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5316 */
5317bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
5318
5319/**
5320 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5321 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5322 *
5323 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5324 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5325 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5326 */
5327void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5328
5329/**
5330 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5331 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5332 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5333 *
5334 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5335 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5336 *
5337 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5338 *
5339 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5340 */
5341struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5342					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5343
5344/**
5345 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5346 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5347 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5348 *
5349 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5350 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5351 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5352 *
5353 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5354 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5355 *
5356 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5357 */
5358struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5359				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5360
5361/**
5362 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5363 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5364 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5365 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5366 *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5367 *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5368 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5369 *	if at all possible
5370 *
5371 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5372 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5373 * BSSID and address is used.
5374 *
5375 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5376 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5377 *
5378 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5379 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5380 *
5381 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5382 */
5383struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5384				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5385				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5386
5387/**
5388 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5389 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5390 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5391 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5392 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5393 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5394 *
5395 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5396 * hardware.
5397 *
5398 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5399 */
5400struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5401				       const u8 *src_addr,
5402				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5403				       size_t tailroom);
5404
5405/**
5406 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5407 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5408 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5409 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5410 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5411 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5412 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5413 *
5414 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5415 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5416 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5417 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5418 */
5419void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5420		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5421		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5422		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5423
5424/**
5425 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5426 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5427 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5428 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5429 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5430 *
5431 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5432 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5433 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5434 *
5435 * Return: The duration.
5436 */
5437__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5438			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5439			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5440
5441/**
5442 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5443 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5444 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5445 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5446 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5447 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5448 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5449 *
5450 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5451 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5452 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5453 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5454 */
5455void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5456			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5457			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5458			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5459			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5460
5461/**
5462 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5463 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5464 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5465 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5466 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5467 *
5468 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5469 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5470 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5471 *
5472 * Return: The duration.
5473 */
5474__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5475				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5476				    size_t frame_len,
5477				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5478
5479/**
5480 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5481 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5482 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5483 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5484 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5485 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5486 *
5487 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5488 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5489 *
5490 * Return: The duration.
5491 */
5492__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5493					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5494					enum nl80211_band band,
5495					size_t frame_len,
5496					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5497
5498/**
5499 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5500 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5501 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5502 *
5503 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5504 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5505 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5506 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5507 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5508 *
5509 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5510 * frames are available.
5511 *
5512 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5513 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5514 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5515 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5516 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5517 * use common code for all beacons.
5518 */
5519struct sk_buff *
5520ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5521
5522/**
5523 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5524 *
5525 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5526 *
5527 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5528 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5529 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5530 */
5531void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5532			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5533
5534/**
5535 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5536 *
5537 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5538 * from the given packet.
5539 *
5540 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5541 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5542 *	with this P1K
5543 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5544 */
5545static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5546					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5547{
5548	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5549	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5550	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5551
5552	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5553}
5554
5555/**
5556 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5557 *
5558 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5559 * and transmitter address.
5560 *
5561 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5562 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5563 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5564 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5565 */
5566void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5567			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5568
5569/**
5570 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5571 *
5572 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5573 * in the packet.
5574 *
5575 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5576 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5577 *	encrypted with this key
5578 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5579 */
5580void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5581			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5582
5583/**
5584 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5585 *
5586 * @pos: start of crypto header
5587 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5588 * @pn: PN to add
5589 *
5590 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5591 * the packet payload)
5592 *
5593 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5594 * point to the crypto header)
5595 */
5596u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5597
5598/**
5599 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5600 *
5601 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5602 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5603 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5604 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5605 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5606 *
5607 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5608 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5609 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5610 *
5611 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5612 * can be done concurrently.
5613 */
5614void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5615			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5616
5617/**
5618 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5619 *
5620 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5621 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5622 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5623 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5624 * @seq: new sequence data
5625 *
5626 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5627 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5628 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5629 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5630 *
5631 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5632 * can be done concurrently.
5633 */
5634void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5635			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5636
5637/**
5638 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5639 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5640 *
 
 
5641 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5642 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5643 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5644 *
5645 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5646 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5647 */
5648void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5649
5650/**
5651 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5652 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5653 * @keyconf: new key data
 
5654 *
5655 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5656 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5657 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5658 *
5659 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5660 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5661 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5662 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5663 *
5664 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5665 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5666 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5667 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5668 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5669 * of the reconfiguration.
5670 *
5671 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5672 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5673 *
5674 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5675 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5676 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5677 * the key that's being replaced.
5678 */
5679struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5680ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5681			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
 
5682
5683/**
5684 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5685 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5686 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5687 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5688 * @gfp: allocation flags
5689 */
5690void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5691				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5692
5693/**
5694 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5695 *
5696 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5697 * at the same time.
5698 *
5699 * @keyconf: the key in question
5700 */
5701void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5702
5703/**
5704 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5705 *
5706 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5707 * at the same time.
5708 *
5709 * @keyconf: the key in question
5710 */
5711void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5712
5713/**
5714 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5715 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5716 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5717 *
5718 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5719 */
5720void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5721
5722/**
5723 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5724 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5725 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5726 *
5727 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5728 */
5729void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5730
5731/**
5732 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5733 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5734 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5735 *
5736 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5737 *
5738 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5739 */
5740
5741int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5742
5743/**
5744 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5745 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5746 *
5747 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5748 */
5749void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5750
5751/**
5752 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5753 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5754 *
5755 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5756 */
5757void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5758
5759/**
5760 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5761 *
5762 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5763 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5764 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5765 * any context, including hardirq context.
5766 *
5767 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5768 * @info: information about the completed scan
5769 */
5770void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5771			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5772
5773/**
5774 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5775 *
5776 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5777 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5778 *
5779 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5780 */
5781void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5782
5783/**
5784 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5785 *
5786 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5787 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5788 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5789 * while associating, for instance.
5790 *
5791 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5792 */
5793void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5794
5795/**
5796 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5797 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5798 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5799 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5800 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5801 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5802 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5803 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5804 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5805 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5806 *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5807 *	for instance.
5808 */
5809enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5810	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5811	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5812	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5813	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5814};
5815
5816/**
5817 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5818 *
5819 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5820 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5821 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5822 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5823 *
5824 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5825 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5826 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5827 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5828 */
5829void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5830				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5831						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5832				  void *data);
5833
5834/**
5835 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5836 *
5837 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5838 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5839 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5840 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5841 * be used.
5842 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5843 *
5844 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5845 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5846 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5847 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5848 */
5849static inline void
5850ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5851				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5852						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5853				    void *data)
5854{
5855	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5856				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5857				     iterator, data);
5858}
5859
5860/**
5861 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5862 *
5863 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5864 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5865 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5866 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5867 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5868 *
5869 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5870 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5871 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5872 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5873 */
5874void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5875						u32 iter_flags,
5876						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5877						    u8 *mac,
5878						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5879						void *data);
5880
5881/**
5882 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5883 *
5884 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5885 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5886 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5887 * The driver must not call this with a lock held that it can also take in
5888 * response to callbacks from mac80211, and it must not call this within
5889 * callbacks made by mac80211 - both would result in deadlocks.
5890 *
5891 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5892 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5893 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5894 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5895 */
5896void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5897					     u32 iter_flags,
5898					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
5899						u8 *mac,
5900						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5901					     void *data);
5902
5903/**
5904 * ieee80211_iterate_stations - iterate stations
5905 *
5906 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5907 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5908 * function for them.
5909 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5910 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic can be used.
5911 *
5912 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5913 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5914 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5915 */
5916void ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5917				void (*iterator)(void *data,
5918						 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5919				void *data);
5920
5921/**
5922 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5923 *
5924 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5925 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5926 * function for them.
5927 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5928 *
5929 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5930 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5931 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5932 */
5933void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5934				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5935						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5936				       void *data);
 
5937/**
5938 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5939 *
5940 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5941 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5942 *
5943 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5944 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5945 */
5946void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5947
5948/**
5949 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5950 *
5951 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5952 * workqueue.
5953 *
5954 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5955 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5956 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5957 */
5958void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5959				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5960				  unsigned long delay);
5961
5962/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5963 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5964 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5965 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5966 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5967 *
5968 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5969 *
5970 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5971 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5972 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5973 */
5974int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5975				  u16 timeout);
5976
5977/**
5978 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5979 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5980 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5981 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5982 *
5983 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5984 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5985 * from any context.
5986 */
5987void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5988				      u16 tid);
5989
5990/**
5991 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5992 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5993 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5994 *
5995 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5996 *
5997 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5998 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5999 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6000 */
6001int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6002
6003/**
6004 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6005 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6006 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6007 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6008 *
6009 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6010 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6011 * can be called from any context.
6012 */
6013void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6014				     u16 tid);
6015
6016/**
6017 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6018 *
6019 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6020 * @addr: station's address
6021 *
6022 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6023 *
6024 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6025 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6026 */
6027struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6028					 const u8 *addr);
6029
6030/**
6031 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6032 *
6033 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6034 * @addr: remote station's address
6035 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6036 *
6037 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6038 *
6039 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6040 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6041 *
6042 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6043 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6044 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6045 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6046 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6047 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6048 *      is not reliable.
6049 *
6050 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6051 */
6052struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6053					       const u8 *addr,
6054					       const u8 *localaddr);
6055
6056/**
6057 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6058 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6059 * @addr: remote station's link address
6060 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6061 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6062 *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6063 *
6064 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
 
 
6065 */
6066struct ieee80211_sta *
6067ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6068				 const u8 *addr,
6069				 const u8 *localaddr,
6070				 unsigned int *link_id);
6071
6072/**
6073 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6074 * @hw: the hardware
6075 * @pubsta: the station
6076 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6077 *
6078 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6079 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6080 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6081 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6082 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6083 *
6084 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6085 * manner.
6086 *
6087 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6088 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6089 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6090 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6091 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6092 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6093 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6094 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6095 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6096 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6097 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6098 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6099 * woke up while blocked or not.
6100 */
6101void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6102			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6103
6104/**
6105 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6106 * @pubsta: the station
6107 *
6108 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6109 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6110 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6111 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6112 *
6113 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6114 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6115 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6116 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6117 *
6118 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6119 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6120 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6121 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6122 */
6123void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6124
6125/**
6126 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6127 * @pubsta: the station
6128 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6129 *
6130 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6131 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6132 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6133 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6134 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6135 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6136 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6137 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6138 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6139 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6140 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6141 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6142 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6143 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6144 */
6145void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6146
6147/**
6148 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6149 * @pubsta: the station
6150 *
6151 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6152 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6153 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6154 *
6155 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6156 * there is no need to call this function.
6157 */
6158void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6159
6160/**
6161 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6162 *
6163 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6164 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6165 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6166 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6167 *
6168 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6169 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6170 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6171 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6172 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6173 * attempts.
6174 *
6175 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6176 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6177 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6178 * them to 0.
6179 *
6180 * @pubsta: the station
6181 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6182 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6183 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6184 */
6185void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6186				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6187
6188/**
6189 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6190 *
6191 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6192 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6193 *
6194 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6195 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6196 */
6197bool
6198ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6199
6200/**
6201 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6202 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6203 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6204 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6205 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6206 *
 
 
6207 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6208 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6209 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6210 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6211 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6212 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6213 *
6214 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6215 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6216 * set_key callback.
6217 */
6218void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6219			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6220			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6221				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6222				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6223				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6224				      void *data),
6225			 void *iter_data);
6226
6227/**
6228 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6229 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6230 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6231 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6232 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6233 *
6234 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6235 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6236 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6237 * in removal process will be skipped.
6238 *
6239 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6240 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6241 */
6242void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6243			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6244			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6245					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6246					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6247					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6248					  void *data),
6249			     void *iter_data);
6250
6251/**
6252 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6253 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6254 * @iter: iterator function
6255 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6256 *
6257 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6258 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6259 * places while calling into the driver.
6260 *
6261 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6262 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6263 * removed.
6264 *
6265 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6266 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6267 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6268 * or not.
6269 */
6270void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6271	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6272	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6273		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6274		     void *data),
6275	void *iter_data);
6276
6277/**
6278 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6279 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6280 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6281 *
6282 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6283 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6284 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6285 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6286 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6287 * %NULL.
6288 *
6289 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6290 */
6291struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6292					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6293
6294/**
6295 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6296 *
6297 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6298 *
6299 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6300 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6301 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6302 */
6303void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6304
6305/**
6306 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6307 *
6308 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6309 *
6310 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6311 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6312 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6313 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6314 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6315 *
6316 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6317 * without connection recovery attempts.
6318 */
6319void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6320
6321/**
6322 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6323 *
6324 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6325 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6326 *
6327 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6328 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6329 */
6330void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6331
6332/**
6333 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6334 *
6335 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6336 *
6337 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6338 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6339 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6340 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6341 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6342 *
6343 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6344 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6345 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6346 * disconnect normally later.
6347 *
6348 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6349 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6350 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6351 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6352 */
6353void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6354
6355/**
6356 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6357 * hardware restart
6358 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6359 *
6360 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6361 * hardware restart.
6362 */
6363void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6364
6365/**
6366 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6367 *	rssi threshold triggered
6368 *
6369 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6370 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6371 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6372 * @gfp: context flags
6373 *
6374 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6375 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6376 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6377 */
6378void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6379			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6380			       s32 rssi_level,
6381			       gfp_t gfp);
6382
6383/**
6384 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6385 *
6386 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6387 * @gfp: context flags
6388 */
6389void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6390
6391/**
6392 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6393 *
6394 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 
 
6395 */
6396void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
6397
6398/**
6399 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6400 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6401 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
 
 
6402 *
6403 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6404 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6405 */
6406void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
 
6407
6408/**
6409 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6410 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6411 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6412 *
6413 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6414 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6415 * a deauth frame in this case.
6416 */
6417void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6418					 bool block_tx);
6419
6420/**
6421 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6422 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6423 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6424 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6425 *
6426 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6427 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6428 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6429 */
6430void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6431			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6432
6433/**
6434 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6435 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6436 */
6437void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6438
6439/**
6440 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6441 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6442 */
6443void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6444
6445/**
6446 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6447 *
6448 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6449 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6450 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6451 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6452 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6453 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6454 *
6455 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6456 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6457 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6458 */
6459void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6460				  const u8 *addr);
6461
6462/**
6463 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6464 * @pubsta: station struct
6465 * @tid: the session's TID
6466 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6467 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6468 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6469 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6470 *
6471 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6472 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6473 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6474 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
 
6475 */
6476void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6477					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6478					  u16 received_mpdus);
6479
6480/**
6481 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6482 *
6483 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6484 * buffer.
6485 *
6486 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6487 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6488 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6489 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6490 */
6491void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6492
6493/**
6494 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6495 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6496 * @addr: station mac address
6497 * @tid: the rx tid
6498 */
6499void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6500				 unsigned int tid);
6501
6502/**
6503 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6504 *
6505 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6506 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6507 * reordering.
6508 *
6509 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6510 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6511 *
6512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6513 * @addr: station mac address
6514 * @tid: the rx tid
6515 */
6516static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6517						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6518{
6519	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6520		return;
6521	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6522}
6523
6524/**
6525 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6526 *
6527 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6528 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6529 * reordering.
6530 *
6531 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6532 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6533 *
6534 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6535 * @addr: station mac address
6536 * @tid: the rx tid
6537 */
6538static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6539						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6540{
6541	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6542		return;
6543	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6544}
6545
6546/**
6547 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6548 *
6549 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6550 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6551 *
6552 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6553 *
6554 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6555 * @addr: station mac address
6556 * @tid: the rx tid
6557 */
6558void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6559				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6560
6561/* Rate control API */
6562
6563/**
6564 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6565 *
6566 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6567 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6568 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6569 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6570 *	to be filled in
6571 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6572 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6573 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6574 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6575 *	RTS threshold
6576 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6577 *	if the selected rate supports it
6578 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6579 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6580 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6581 */
6582struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6583	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6584	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6585	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6586	struct sk_buff *skb;
6587	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6588	bool rts, short_preamble;
6589	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6590	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6591	bool bss;
6592};
6593
6594/**
6595 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6596 */
6597enum rate_control_capabilities {
6598	/**
6599	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6600	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6601	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6602	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6603	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6604	 */
6605	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6606	/**
6607	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6608	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6609	 */
6610	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6611};
6612
6613struct rate_control_ops {
6614	unsigned long capa;
6615	const char *name;
6616	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6617	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6618			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6619	void (*free)(void *priv);
6620
6621	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6622	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6623			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6624			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6625	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6626			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6627			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6628			    u32 changed);
6629	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6630			 void *priv_sta);
6631
6632	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6633			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6634			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6635	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6636			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6637			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6638	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6639			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6640
6641	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6642				struct dentry *dir);
6643
6644	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6645};
6646
6647static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6648				 enum nl80211_band band,
6649				 int index)
6650{
6651	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6652}
6653
6654static inline s8
6655rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6656		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6657{
6658	int i;
6659
6660	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6661		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6662			return i;
6663
6664	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6665	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6666
6667	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6668	return 0;
6669}
6670
6671static inline
6672bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6673			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6674{
6675	unsigned int i;
6676
6677	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6678		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6679			return true;
6680	return false;
6681}
6682
6683/**
6684 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6685 *
6686 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6687 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6688 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6689 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6690 *
6691 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6692 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6693 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
 
 
6694 */
6695int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6696			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6697			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6698
6699int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6700void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6701
6702static inline bool
6703conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6704{
6705	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6706}
6707
6708static inline bool
6709conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6710{
6711	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6712	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6713}
6714
6715static inline bool
6716conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6717{
6718	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6719	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6720}
6721
6722static inline bool
6723conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6724{
6725	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6726}
6727
6728static inline bool
6729conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6730{
6731	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6732		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6733		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6734}
6735
6736static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6737ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6738{
6739	if (p2p) {
6740		switch (type) {
6741		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6742			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6743		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6744			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6745		default:
6746			break;
6747		}
6748	}
6749	return type;
6750}
6751
6752static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6753ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6754{
6755	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6756}
6757
6758/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6759 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6760 *
6761 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6762 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6763 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6764 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6765 *
6766 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6767 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6768 * matching GroupId management frame.
6769 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6770 */
6771void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6772				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6773
6774void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6775				   int rssi_min_thold,
6776				   int rssi_max_thold);
6777
6778void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6779
6780/**
6781 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6782 *
6783 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6784 *
6785 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6786 *
6787 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6788 * applicable.
6789 */
6790int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6791
6792/**
6793 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6794 * @vif: virtual interface
6795 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6796 * @gfp: allocation flags
6797 *
6798 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6799 */
6800void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6801				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6802				    gfp_t gfp);
6803
6804/**
6805 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6806 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6807 * @vif: virtual interface
6808 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6809 * @band: the band to transmit on
6810 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6811 *
 
 
6812 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6813 */
6814bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6815			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6816			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6817
6818/**
6819 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6820 *				 of injected frames.
6821 *
6822 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6823 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6824 * of the skb before calling this function.
6825 *
6826 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6827 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
 
 
6828 */
6829bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6830				 struct net_device *dev);
6831
6832/**
6833 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6834 *
6835 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6836 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6837 *
6838 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6839 *
6840 * private:
6841 *
6842 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6843 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6844 */
6845struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6846	u32 next_tsf;
6847	bool has_next_tsf;
6848
6849	u8 absent;
6850
6851	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6852	struct {
6853		u32 start;
6854		u32 duration;
6855		u32 interval;
6856	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6857};
6858
6859/**
6860 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6861 *
6862 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6863 * @data: NoA tracking data
6864 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6865 *
6866 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6867 */
6868int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6869			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6870
6871/**
6872 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6873 *
6874 * @data: NoA tracking data
6875 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6876 */
6877void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6878
6879/**
6880 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6881 * @vif: virtual interface
6882 * @peer: the peer's destination address
6883 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6884 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6885 * @gfp: allocation flags
6886 *
6887 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6888 */
6889void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6890				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6891				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6892
6893/**
6894 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6895 *
6896 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6897 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6898 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6899 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6900 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6901 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6902 *
6903 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6904 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6905 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6906 *
6907 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6908 * @tid: the TID to reserve
6909 *
6910 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6911 */
6912int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6913
6914/**
6915 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6916 *
6917 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6918 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6919 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6920 *
6921 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6922 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6923 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6924 *
6925 * @sta: the station
6926 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6927 */
6928void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6929
6930/**
6931 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6932 *
6933 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6934 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6935 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6936 *
6937 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6938 *
6939 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6940 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6941 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6942 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6943 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6944 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6945 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6946 *
6947 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6948 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6949 */
6950struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6951				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6952
6953/**
6954 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6955 * (in process context)
6956 *
6957 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6958 * (internally disables bottom halves).
6959 *
6960 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6961 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6962 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
 
 
6963 */
6964static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6965						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6966{
6967	struct sk_buff *skb;
6968
6969	local_bh_disable();
6970	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6971	local_bh_enable();
6972
6973	return skb;
6974}
6975
6976/**
6977 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
6978 *
6979 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
6980 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
6981 *
6982 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
6983 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
6984 */
6985void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6986				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6987
6988/**
6989 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6990 *
6991 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6992 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6993 *
6994 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6995 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6996 * driver has finished scheduling it.
6997 */
6998struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6999
7000/**
7001 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7002 *
7003 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7004 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7005 *
7006 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7007 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7008 */
7009void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7010
7011/* (deprecated) */
7012static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7013{
7014}
7015
7016void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7017			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7018
7019/**
7020 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7021 *
7022 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7023 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7024 *
7025 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7026 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7027 *
7028 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7029 * this TXQ internally.
7030 */
7031static inline void
7032ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7033{
7034	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7035}
7036
7037/**
7038 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7039 *
7040 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7041 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7042 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7043 *
7044 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7045 * internally.
7046 */
7047static inline void
7048ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7049		     bool force)
7050{
7051	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7052}
7053
7054/**
7055 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7056 *
7057 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7058 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7059 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7060 * next_txq().
7061 *
7062 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7063 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7064 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7065 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7066 * again.
7067 *
7068 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7069 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7070 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7071 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7072 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7073 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7074 *
7075 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7076 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 
 
7077 */
7078bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7079				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7080
7081/**
7082 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7083 *
7084 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7085 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7086 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7087 *
7088 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7089 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7090 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7091 */
7092void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7093			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7094			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7095
7096/**
7097 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7098 *
7099 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7100 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7101 *
7102 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7103 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7104 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7105 * @gfp: allocation flags
7106 */
7107void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7108				   u8 inst_id,
7109				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7110				   gfp_t gfp);
7111
7112/**
7113 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7114 *
7115 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7116 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7117 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7118 *
7119 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7120 * @match: match event information
7121 * @gfp: allocation flags
7122 */
7123void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7124			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7125			      gfp_t gfp);
7126
7127/**
7128 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7129 *
7130 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7131 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7132 *
7133 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7134 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7135 *          information.
7136 * @len: frame length in bytes
 
 
7137 */
7138u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7139			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7140			      int len);
7141
7142/**
7143 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7144 *
7145 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7146 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7147 *
7148 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7149 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7150 * @len: frame length in bytes
 
 
7151 */
7152u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7153			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7154			      int len);
7155/**
7156 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7157 *
7158 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7159 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7160 * hardware or firmware.
7161 *
7162 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7163 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7164 */
7165bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7166
7167/**
7168 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7169 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7170 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7171 *
7172 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7173 *
7174 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7175 */
7176struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7177						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7178
7179/**
7180 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7181 *	probe response template.
7182 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7183 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7184 *
7185 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7186 *
7187 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7188 */
7189struct sk_buff *
7190ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7191					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7192
7193/**
7194 * ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7195 * collision.
 
7196 *
7197 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7198 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7199 *	aware of.
7200 * @gfp: allocation flags
7201 */
7202void
7203ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7204				       u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7205
7206/**
7207 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7208 *
7209 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7210 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7211 *
7212 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
 
 
7213 */
7214static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7215{
7216	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7217	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7218
7219	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7220	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7221}
7222
7223/**
7224 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7225 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7226 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7227 *
 
 
 
7228 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7229 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7230 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7231 *
7232 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7233 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7234 * a sequence of calls like
 
7235 *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7236 *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
 
7237 *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7238 *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7239 *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7240 *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7241 *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7242 *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7243 *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7244 *
7245 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7246 *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7247 *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7248 */
7249int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7250
7251/**
7252 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7253 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7254 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7255 *
7256 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7257 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7258 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7259 * completed after it returns.
7260 */
7261void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7262				      u16 active_links);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7263
7264#endif /* MAC80211_H */